1 | /* tc-hppa.c -- Assemble for the PA
|
---|
2 | Copyright 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
|
---|
3 | 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
---|
4 |
|
---|
5 | This file is part of GAS, the GNU Assembler.
|
---|
6 |
|
---|
7 | GAS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
---|
8 | it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
---|
9 | the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
---|
10 | any later version.
|
---|
11 |
|
---|
12 | GAS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
---|
13 | but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
---|
14 | MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
---|
15 | GNU General Public License for more details.
|
---|
16 |
|
---|
17 | You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
---|
18 | along with GAS; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
|
---|
19 | Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
|
---|
20 | 02111-1307, USA. */
|
---|
21 |
|
---|
22 | /* HP PA-RISC support was contributed by the Center for Software Science
|
---|
23 | at the University of Utah. */
|
---|
24 |
|
---|
25 | #include <stdio.h>
|
---|
26 |
|
---|
27 | #include "as.h"
|
---|
28 | #include "safe-ctype.h"
|
---|
29 | #include "subsegs.h"
|
---|
30 |
|
---|
31 | #include "bfd/libhppa.h"
|
---|
32 |
|
---|
33 | /* Be careful, this file includes data *declarations*. */
|
---|
34 | #include "opcode/hppa.h"
|
---|
35 |
|
---|
36 | #if defined (OBJ_ELF) && defined (OBJ_SOM)
|
---|
37 | error only one of OBJ_ELF and OBJ_SOM can be defined
|
---|
38 | #endif
|
---|
39 |
|
---|
40 | /* If we are using ELF, then we probably can support dwarf2 debug
|
---|
41 | records. Furthermore, if we are supporting dwarf2 debug records,
|
---|
42 | then we want to use the assembler support for compact line numbers. */
|
---|
43 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
44 | #include "dwarf2dbg.h"
|
---|
45 |
|
---|
46 | /* A "convient" place to put object file dependencies which do
|
---|
47 | not need to be seen outside of tc-hppa.c. */
|
---|
48 |
|
---|
49 | /* Object file formats specify relocation types. */
|
---|
50 | typedef enum elf_hppa_reloc_type reloc_type;
|
---|
51 |
|
---|
52 | /* Object file formats specify BFD symbol types. */
|
---|
53 | typedef elf_symbol_type obj_symbol_type;
|
---|
54 | #define symbol_arg_reloc_info(sym)\
|
---|
55 | (((obj_symbol_type *) symbol_get_bfdsym (sym))->tc_data.hppa_arg_reloc)
|
---|
56 |
|
---|
57 | #if TARGET_ARCH_SIZE == 64
|
---|
58 | /* How to generate a relocation. */
|
---|
59 | #define hppa_gen_reloc_type _bfd_elf64_hppa_gen_reloc_type
|
---|
60 | #define elf_hppa_reloc_final_type elf64_hppa_reloc_final_type
|
---|
61 | #else
|
---|
62 | #define hppa_gen_reloc_type _bfd_elf32_hppa_gen_reloc_type
|
---|
63 | #define elf_hppa_reloc_final_type elf32_hppa_reloc_final_type
|
---|
64 | #endif
|
---|
65 |
|
---|
66 | /* ELF objects can have versions, but apparently do not have anywhere
|
---|
67 | to store a copyright string. */
|
---|
68 | #define obj_version obj_elf_version
|
---|
69 | #define obj_copyright obj_elf_version
|
---|
70 |
|
---|
71 | #define UNWIND_SECTION_NAME ".PARISC.unwind"
|
---|
72 | #endif /* OBJ_ELF */
|
---|
73 |
|
---|
74 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
75 | /* Names of various debugging spaces/subspaces. */
|
---|
76 | #define GDB_DEBUG_SPACE_NAME "$GDB_DEBUG$"
|
---|
77 | #define GDB_STRINGS_SUBSPACE_NAME "$GDB_STRINGS$"
|
---|
78 | #define GDB_SYMBOLS_SUBSPACE_NAME "$GDB_SYMBOLS$"
|
---|
79 | #define UNWIND_SECTION_NAME "$UNWIND$"
|
---|
80 |
|
---|
81 | /* Object file formats specify relocation types. */
|
---|
82 | typedef int reloc_type;
|
---|
83 |
|
---|
84 | /* SOM objects can have both a version string and a copyright string. */
|
---|
85 | #define obj_version obj_som_version
|
---|
86 | #define obj_copyright obj_som_copyright
|
---|
87 |
|
---|
88 | /* How to generate a relocation. */
|
---|
89 | #define hppa_gen_reloc_type hppa_som_gen_reloc_type
|
---|
90 |
|
---|
91 | /* Object file formats specify BFD symbol types. */
|
---|
92 | typedef som_symbol_type obj_symbol_type;
|
---|
93 | #define symbol_arg_reloc_info(sym)\
|
---|
94 | (((obj_symbol_type *) symbol_get_bfdsym (sym))->tc_data.ap.hppa_arg_reloc)
|
---|
95 |
|
---|
96 | /* This apparently isn't in older versions of hpux reloc.h. */
|
---|
97 | #ifndef R_DLT_REL
|
---|
98 | #define R_DLT_REL 0x78
|
---|
99 | #endif
|
---|
100 |
|
---|
101 | #ifndef R_N0SEL
|
---|
102 | #define R_N0SEL 0xd8
|
---|
103 | #endif
|
---|
104 |
|
---|
105 | #ifndef R_N1SEL
|
---|
106 | #define R_N1SEL 0xd9
|
---|
107 | #endif
|
---|
108 | #endif /* OBJ_SOM */
|
---|
109 |
|
---|
110 | #if TARGET_ARCH_SIZE == 64
|
---|
111 | #define DEFAULT_LEVEL 25
|
---|
112 | #else
|
---|
113 | #define DEFAULT_LEVEL 10
|
---|
114 | #endif
|
---|
115 |
|
---|
116 | /* Various structures and types used internally in tc-hppa.c. */
|
---|
117 |
|
---|
118 | /* Unwind table and descriptor. FIXME: Sync this with GDB version. */
|
---|
119 |
|
---|
120 | struct unwind_desc
|
---|
121 | {
|
---|
122 | unsigned int cannot_unwind:1;
|
---|
123 | unsigned int millicode:1;
|
---|
124 | unsigned int millicode_save_rest:1;
|
---|
125 | unsigned int region_desc:2;
|
---|
126 | unsigned int save_sr:2;
|
---|
127 | unsigned int entry_fr:4;
|
---|
128 | unsigned int entry_gr:5;
|
---|
129 | unsigned int args_stored:1;
|
---|
130 | unsigned int call_fr:5;
|
---|
131 | unsigned int call_gr:5;
|
---|
132 | unsigned int save_sp:1;
|
---|
133 | unsigned int save_rp:1;
|
---|
134 | unsigned int save_rp_in_frame:1;
|
---|
135 | unsigned int extn_ptr_defined:1;
|
---|
136 | unsigned int cleanup_defined:1;
|
---|
137 |
|
---|
138 | unsigned int hpe_interrupt_marker:1;
|
---|
139 | unsigned int hpux_interrupt_marker:1;
|
---|
140 | unsigned int reserved:3;
|
---|
141 | unsigned int frame_size:27;
|
---|
142 | };
|
---|
143 |
|
---|
144 | /* We can't rely on compilers placing bitfields in any particular
|
---|
145 | place, so use these macros when dumping unwind descriptors to
|
---|
146 | object files. */
|
---|
147 | #define UNWIND_LOW32(U) \
|
---|
148 | (((U)->cannot_unwind << 31) \
|
---|
149 | | ((U)->millicode << 30) \
|
---|
150 | | ((U)->millicode_save_rest << 29) \
|
---|
151 | | ((U)->region_desc << 27) \
|
---|
152 | | ((U)->save_sr << 25) \
|
---|
153 | | ((U)->entry_fr << 21) \
|
---|
154 | | ((U)->entry_gr << 16) \
|
---|
155 | | ((U)->args_stored << 15) \
|
---|
156 | | ((U)->call_fr << 10) \
|
---|
157 | | ((U)->call_gr << 5) \
|
---|
158 | | ((U)->save_sp << 4) \
|
---|
159 | | ((U)->save_rp << 3) \
|
---|
160 | | ((U)->save_rp_in_frame << 2) \
|
---|
161 | | ((U)->extn_ptr_defined << 1) \
|
---|
162 | | ((U)->cleanup_defined << 0))
|
---|
163 |
|
---|
164 | #define UNWIND_HIGH32(U) \
|
---|
165 | (((U)->hpe_interrupt_marker << 31) \
|
---|
166 | | ((U)->hpux_interrupt_marker << 30) \
|
---|
167 | | ((U)->frame_size << 0))
|
---|
168 |
|
---|
169 | struct unwind_table
|
---|
170 | {
|
---|
171 | /* Starting and ending offsets of the region described by
|
---|
172 | descriptor. */
|
---|
173 | unsigned int start_offset;
|
---|
174 | unsigned int end_offset;
|
---|
175 | struct unwind_desc descriptor;
|
---|
176 | };
|
---|
177 |
|
---|
178 | /* This structure is used by the .callinfo, .enter, .leave pseudo-ops to
|
---|
179 | control the entry and exit code they generate. It is also used in
|
---|
180 | creation of the correct stack unwind descriptors.
|
---|
181 |
|
---|
182 | NOTE: GAS does not support .enter and .leave for the generation of
|
---|
183 | prologues and epilogues. FIXME.
|
---|
184 |
|
---|
185 | The fields in structure roughly correspond to the arguments available on the
|
---|
186 | .callinfo pseudo-op. */
|
---|
187 |
|
---|
188 | struct call_info
|
---|
189 | {
|
---|
190 | /* The unwind descriptor being built. */
|
---|
191 | struct unwind_table ci_unwind;
|
---|
192 |
|
---|
193 | /* Name of this function. */
|
---|
194 | symbolS *start_symbol;
|
---|
195 |
|
---|
196 | /* (temporary) symbol used to mark the end of this function. */
|
---|
197 | symbolS *end_symbol;
|
---|
198 |
|
---|
199 | /* Next entry in the chain. */
|
---|
200 | struct call_info *ci_next;
|
---|
201 | };
|
---|
202 |
|
---|
203 | /* Operand formats for FP instructions. Note not all FP instructions
|
---|
204 | allow all four formats to be used (for example fmpysub only allows
|
---|
205 | SGL and DBL). */
|
---|
206 | typedef enum
|
---|
207 | {
|
---|
208 | SGL, DBL, ILLEGAL_FMT, QUAD, W, UW, DW, UDW, QW, UQW
|
---|
209 | }
|
---|
210 | fp_operand_format;
|
---|
211 |
|
---|
212 | /* This fully describes the symbol types which may be attached to
|
---|
213 | an EXPORT or IMPORT directive. Only SOM uses this formation
|
---|
214 | (ELF has no need for it). */
|
---|
215 | typedef enum
|
---|
216 | {
|
---|
217 | SYMBOL_TYPE_UNKNOWN,
|
---|
218 | SYMBOL_TYPE_ABSOLUTE,
|
---|
219 | SYMBOL_TYPE_CODE,
|
---|
220 | SYMBOL_TYPE_DATA,
|
---|
221 | SYMBOL_TYPE_ENTRY,
|
---|
222 | SYMBOL_TYPE_MILLICODE,
|
---|
223 | SYMBOL_TYPE_PLABEL,
|
---|
224 | SYMBOL_TYPE_PRI_PROG,
|
---|
225 | SYMBOL_TYPE_SEC_PROG,
|
---|
226 | }
|
---|
227 | pa_symbol_type;
|
---|
228 |
|
---|
229 | /* This structure contains information needed to assemble
|
---|
230 | individual instructions. */
|
---|
231 | struct pa_it
|
---|
232 | {
|
---|
233 | /* Holds the opcode after parsing by pa_ip. */
|
---|
234 | unsigned long opcode;
|
---|
235 |
|
---|
236 | /* Holds an expression associated with the current instruction. */
|
---|
237 | expressionS exp;
|
---|
238 |
|
---|
239 | /* Does this instruction use PC-relative addressing. */
|
---|
240 | int pcrel;
|
---|
241 |
|
---|
242 | /* Floating point formats for operand1 and operand2. */
|
---|
243 | fp_operand_format fpof1;
|
---|
244 | fp_operand_format fpof2;
|
---|
245 |
|
---|
246 | /* Whether or not we saw a truncation request on an fcnv insn. */
|
---|
247 | int trunc;
|
---|
248 |
|
---|
249 | /* Holds the field selector for this instruction
|
---|
250 | (for example L%, LR%, etc). */
|
---|
251 | long field_selector;
|
---|
252 |
|
---|
253 | /* Holds any argument relocation bits associated with this
|
---|
254 | instruction. (instruction should be some sort of call). */
|
---|
255 | unsigned int arg_reloc;
|
---|
256 |
|
---|
257 | /* The format specification for this instruction. */
|
---|
258 | int format;
|
---|
259 |
|
---|
260 | /* The relocation (if any) associated with this instruction. */
|
---|
261 | reloc_type reloc;
|
---|
262 | };
|
---|
263 |
|
---|
264 | /* PA-89 floating point registers are arranged like this:
|
---|
265 |
|
---|
266 | +--------------+--------------+
|
---|
267 | | 0 or 16L | 16 or 16R |
|
---|
268 | +--------------+--------------+
|
---|
269 | | 1 or 17L | 17 or 17R |
|
---|
270 | +--------------+--------------+
|
---|
271 | | | |
|
---|
272 |
|
---|
273 | . . .
|
---|
274 | . . .
|
---|
275 | . . .
|
---|
276 |
|
---|
277 | | | |
|
---|
278 | +--------------+--------------+
|
---|
279 | | 14 or 30L | 30 or 30R |
|
---|
280 | +--------------+--------------+
|
---|
281 | | 15 or 31L | 31 or 31R |
|
---|
282 | +--------------+--------------+ */
|
---|
283 |
|
---|
284 | /* Additional information needed to build argument relocation stubs. */
|
---|
285 | struct call_desc
|
---|
286 | {
|
---|
287 | /* The argument relocation specification. */
|
---|
288 | unsigned int arg_reloc;
|
---|
289 |
|
---|
290 | /* Number of arguments. */
|
---|
291 | unsigned int arg_count;
|
---|
292 | };
|
---|
293 |
|
---|
294 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
295 | /* This structure defines an entry in the subspace dictionary
|
---|
296 | chain. */
|
---|
297 |
|
---|
298 | struct subspace_dictionary_chain
|
---|
299 | {
|
---|
300 | /* Nonzero if this space has been defined by the user code. */
|
---|
301 | unsigned int ssd_defined;
|
---|
302 |
|
---|
303 | /* Name of this subspace. */
|
---|
304 | char *ssd_name;
|
---|
305 |
|
---|
306 | /* GAS segment and subsegment associated with this subspace. */
|
---|
307 | asection *ssd_seg;
|
---|
308 | int ssd_subseg;
|
---|
309 |
|
---|
310 | /* Next space in the subspace dictionary chain. */
|
---|
311 | struct subspace_dictionary_chain *ssd_next;
|
---|
312 | };
|
---|
313 |
|
---|
314 | typedef struct subspace_dictionary_chain ssd_chain_struct;
|
---|
315 |
|
---|
316 | /* This structure defines an entry in the subspace dictionary
|
---|
317 | chain. */
|
---|
318 |
|
---|
319 | struct space_dictionary_chain
|
---|
320 | {
|
---|
321 | /* Nonzero if this space has been defined by the user code or
|
---|
322 | as a default space. */
|
---|
323 | unsigned int sd_defined;
|
---|
324 |
|
---|
325 | /* Nonzero if this spaces has been defined by the user code. */
|
---|
326 | unsigned int sd_user_defined;
|
---|
327 |
|
---|
328 | /* The space number (or index). */
|
---|
329 | unsigned int sd_spnum;
|
---|
330 |
|
---|
331 | /* The name of this subspace. */
|
---|
332 | char *sd_name;
|
---|
333 |
|
---|
334 | /* GAS segment to which this subspace corresponds. */
|
---|
335 | asection *sd_seg;
|
---|
336 |
|
---|
337 | /* Current subsegment number being used. */
|
---|
338 | int sd_last_subseg;
|
---|
339 |
|
---|
340 | /* The chain of subspaces contained within this space. */
|
---|
341 | ssd_chain_struct *sd_subspaces;
|
---|
342 |
|
---|
343 | /* The next entry in the space dictionary chain. */
|
---|
344 | struct space_dictionary_chain *sd_next;
|
---|
345 | };
|
---|
346 |
|
---|
347 | typedef struct space_dictionary_chain sd_chain_struct;
|
---|
348 |
|
---|
349 | /* This structure defines attributes of the default subspace
|
---|
350 | dictionary entries. */
|
---|
351 |
|
---|
352 | struct default_subspace_dict
|
---|
353 | {
|
---|
354 | /* Name of the subspace. */
|
---|
355 | char *name;
|
---|
356 |
|
---|
357 | /* FIXME. Is this still needed? */
|
---|
358 | char defined;
|
---|
359 |
|
---|
360 | /* Nonzero if this subspace is loadable. */
|
---|
361 | char loadable;
|
---|
362 |
|
---|
363 | /* Nonzero if this subspace contains only code. */
|
---|
364 | char code_only;
|
---|
365 |
|
---|
366 | /* Nonzero if this is a common subspace. */
|
---|
367 | char common;
|
---|
368 |
|
---|
369 | /* Nonzero if this is a common subspace which allows symbols
|
---|
370 | to be multiply defined. */
|
---|
371 | char dup_common;
|
---|
372 |
|
---|
373 | /* Nonzero if this subspace should be zero filled. */
|
---|
374 | char zero;
|
---|
375 |
|
---|
376 | /* Sort key for this subspace. */
|
---|
377 | unsigned char sort;
|
---|
378 |
|
---|
379 | /* Access control bits for this subspace. Can represent RWX access
|
---|
380 | as well as privilege level changes for gateways. */
|
---|
381 | int access;
|
---|
382 |
|
---|
383 | /* Index of containing space. */
|
---|
384 | int space_index;
|
---|
385 |
|
---|
386 | /* Alignment (in bytes) of this subspace. */
|
---|
387 | int alignment;
|
---|
388 |
|
---|
389 | /* Quadrant within space where this subspace should be loaded. */
|
---|
390 | int quadrant;
|
---|
391 |
|
---|
392 | /* An index into the default spaces array. */
|
---|
393 | int def_space_index;
|
---|
394 |
|
---|
395 | /* Subsegment associated with this subspace. */
|
---|
396 | subsegT subsegment;
|
---|
397 | };
|
---|
398 |
|
---|
399 | /* This structure defines attributes of the default space
|
---|
400 | dictionary entries. */
|
---|
401 |
|
---|
402 | struct default_space_dict
|
---|
403 | {
|
---|
404 | /* Name of the space. */
|
---|
405 | char *name;
|
---|
406 |
|
---|
407 | /* Space number. It is possible to identify spaces within
|
---|
408 | assembly code numerically! */
|
---|
409 | int spnum;
|
---|
410 |
|
---|
411 | /* Nonzero if this space is loadable. */
|
---|
412 | char loadable;
|
---|
413 |
|
---|
414 | /* Nonzero if this space is "defined". FIXME is still needed */
|
---|
415 | char defined;
|
---|
416 |
|
---|
417 | /* Nonzero if this space can not be shared. */
|
---|
418 | char private;
|
---|
419 |
|
---|
420 | /* Sort key for this space. */
|
---|
421 | unsigned char sort;
|
---|
422 |
|
---|
423 | /* Segment associated with this space. */
|
---|
424 | asection *segment;
|
---|
425 | };
|
---|
426 | #endif
|
---|
427 |
|
---|
428 | /* Structure for previous label tracking. Needed so that alignments,
|
---|
429 | callinfo declarations, etc can be easily attached to a particular
|
---|
430 | label. */
|
---|
431 | typedef struct label_symbol_struct
|
---|
432 | {
|
---|
433 | struct symbol *lss_label;
|
---|
434 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
435 | sd_chain_struct *lss_space;
|
---|
436 | #endif
|
---|
437 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
438 | segT lss_segment;
|
---|
439 | #endif
|
---|
440 | struct label_symbol_struct *lss_next;
|
---|
441 | }
|
---|
442 | label_symbol_struct;
|
---|
443 |
|
---|
444 | /* Extra information needed to perform fixups (relocations) on the PA. */
|
---|
445 | struct hppa_fix_struct
|
---|
446 | {
|
---|
447 | /* The field selector. */
|
---|
448 | enum hppa_reloc_field_selector_type_alt fx_r_field;
|
---|
449 |
|
---|
450 | /* Type of fixup. */
|
---|
451 | int fx_r_type;
|
---|
452 |
|
---|
453 | /* Format of fixup. */
|
---|
454 | int fx_r_format;
|
---|
455 |
|
---|
456 | /* Argument relocation bits. */
|
---|
457 | unsigned int fx_arg_reloc;
|
---|
458 |
|
---|
459 | /* The segment this fixup appears in. */
|
---|
460 | segT segment;
|
---|
461 | };
|
---|
462 |
|
---|
463 | /* Structure to hold information about predefined registers. */
|
---|
464 |
|
---|
465 | struct pd_reg
|
---|
466 | {
|
---|
467 | char *name;
|
---|
468 | int value;
|
---|
469 | };
|
---|
470 |
|
---|
471 | /* This structure defines the mapping from a FP condition string
|
---|
472 | to a condition number which can be recorded in an instruction. */
|
---|
473 | struct fp_cond_map
|
---|
474 | {
|
---|
475 | char *string;
|
---|
476 | int cond;
|
---|
477 | };
|
---|
478 |
|
---|
479 | /* This structure defines a mapping from a field selector
|
---|
480 | string to a field selector type. */
|
---|
481 | struct selector_entry
|
---|
482 | {
|
---|
483 | char *prefix;
|
---|
484 | int field_selector;
|
---|
485 | };
|
---|
486 |
|
---|
487 | /* Prototypes for functions local to tc-hppa.c. */
|
---|
488 |
|
---|
489 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
490 | static void pa_check_current_space_and_subspace PARAMS ((void));
|
---|
491 | #endif
|
---|
492 |
|
---|
493 | #if !(defined (OBJ_ELF) && defined (TE_LINUX))
|
---|
494 | static void pa_text PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
495 | static void pa_data PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
496 | static void pa_comm PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
497 | #endif
|
---|
498 | static fp_operand_format pa_parse_fp_format PARAMS ((char **s));
|
---|
499 | static void pa_cons PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
500 | static void pa_float_cons PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
501 | static void pa_fill PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
502 | static void pa_lcomm PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
503 | static void pa_lsym PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
504 | static void pa_stringer PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
505 | static void pa_version PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
506 | static int pa_parse_fp_cmp_cond PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
507 | static int get_expression PARAMS ((char *));
|
---|
508 | static int pa_get_absolute_expression PARAMS ((struct pa_it *, char **));
|
---|
509 | static int evaluate_absolute PARAMS ((struct pa_it *));
|
---|
510 | static unsigned int pa_build_arg_reloc PARAMS ((char *));
|
---|
511 | static unsigned int pa_align_arg_reloc PARAMS ((unsigned int, unsigned int));
|
---|
512 | static int pa_parse_nullif PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
513 | static int pa_parse_nonneg_cmpsub_cmpltr PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
514 | static int pa_parse_neg_cmpsub_cmpltr PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
515 | static int pa_parse_neg_add_cmpltr PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
516 | static int pa_parse_nonneg_add_cmpltr PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
517 | static int pa_parse_cmpb_64_cmpltr PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
518 | static int pa_parse_cmpib_64_cmpltr PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
519 | static int pa_parse_addb_64_cmpltr PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
520 | static void pa_block PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
521 | static void pa_brtab PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
522 | static void pa_try PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
523 | static void pa_call PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
524 | static void pa_call_args PARAMS ((struct call_desc *));
|
---|
525 | static void pa_callinfo PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
526 | static void pa_copyright PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
527 | static void pa_end PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
528 | static void pa_enter PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
529 | static void pa_entry PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
530 | static void pa_equ PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
531 | static void pa_exit PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
532 | static void pa_export PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
533 | static void pa_type_args PARAMS ((symbolS *, int));
|
---|
534 | static void pa_import PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
535 | static void pa_label PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
536 | static void pa_leave PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
537 | static void pa_level PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
538 | static void pa_origin PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
539 | static void pa_proc PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
540 | static void pa_procend PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
541 | static void pa_param PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
542 | static void pa_undefine_label PARAMS ((void));
|
---|
543 | static int need_pa11_opcode PARAMS ((void));
|
---|
544 | static int pa_parse_number PARAMS ((char **, int));
|
---|
545 | static label_symbol_struct *pa_get_label PARAMS ((void));
|
---|
546 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
547 | static int log2 PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
548 | static void pa_compiler PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
549 | static void pa_align PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
550 | static void pa_space PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
551 | static void pa_spnum PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
552 | static void pa_subspace PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
553 | static sd_chain_struct *create_new_space PARAMS ((char *, int, int,
|
---|
554 | int, int, int,
|
---|
555 | asection *, int));
|
---|
556 | static ssd_chain_struct *create_new_subspace PARAMS ((sd_chain_struct *,
|
---|
557 | char *, int, int,
|
---|
558 | int, int, int,
|
---|
559 | int, int, int, int,
|
---|
560 | int, asection *));
|
---|
561 | static ssd_chain_struct *update_subspace PARAMS ((sd_chain_struct *,
|
---|
562 | char *, int, int, int,
|
---|
563 | int, int, int, int,
|
---|
564 | int, int, int,
|
---|
565 | asection *));
|
---|
566 | static sd_chain_struct *is_defined_space PARAMS ((char *));
|
---|
567 | static ssd_chain_struct *is_defined_subspace PARAMS ((char *));
|
---|
568 | static sd_chain_struct *pa_segment_to_space PARAMS ((asection *));
|
---|
569 | static ssd_chain_struct *pa_subsegment_to_subspace PARAMS ((asection *,
|
---|
570 | subsegT));
|
---|
571 | static sd_chain_struct *pa_find_space_by_number PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
572 | static unsigned int pa_subspace_start PARAMS ((sd_chain_struct *, int));
|
---|
573 | static sd_chain_struct *pa_parse_space_stmt PARAMS ((char *, int));
|
---|
574 | static int pa_next_subseg PARAMS ((sd_chain_struct *));
|
---|
575 | static void pa_spaces_begin PARAMS ((void));
|
---|
576 | #endif
|
---|
577 | static void pa_ip PARAMS ((char *));
|
---|
578 | static void fix_new_hppa PARAMS ((fragS *, int, int, symbolS *,
|
---|
579 | offsetT, expressionS *, int,
|
---|
580 | bfd_reloc_code_real_type,
|
---|
581 | enum hppa_reloc_field_selector_type_alt,
|
---|
582 | int, unsigned int, int));
|
---|
583 | static int is_end_of_statement PARAMS ((void));
|
---|
584 | static int reg_name_search PARAMS ((char *));
|
---|
585 | static int pa_chk_field_selector PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
586 | static int is_same_frag PARAMS ((fragS *, fragS *));
|
---|
587 | static void process_exit PARAMS ((void));
|
---|
588 | static unsigned int pa_stringer_aux PARAMS ((char *));
|
---|
589 | static fp_operand_format pa_parse_fp_cnv_format PARAMS ((char **s));
|
---|
590 | static int pa_parse_ftest_gfx_completer PARAMS ((char **));
|
---|
591 |
|
---|
592 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
593 | static void hppa_elf_mark_end_of_function PARAMS ((void));
|
---|
594 | static void pa_build_unwind_subspace PARAMS ((struct call_info *));
|
---|
595 | static void pa_vtable_entry PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
596 | static void pa_vtable_inherit PARAMS ((int));
|
---|
597 | #endif
|
---|
598 |
|
---|
599 | /* File and gloally scoped variable declarations. */
|
---|
600 |
|
---|
601 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
602 | /* Root and final entry in the space chain. */
|
---|
603 | static sd_chain_struct *space_dict_root;
|
---|
604 | static sd_chain_struct *space_dict_last;
|
---|
605 |
|
---|
606 | /* The current space and subspace. */
|
---|
607 | static sd_chain_struct *current_space;
|
---|
608 | static ssd_chain_struct *current_subspace;
|
---|
609 | #endif
|
---|
610 |
|
---|
611 | /* Root of the call_info chain. */
|
---|
612 | static struct call_info *call_info_root;
|
---|
613 |
|
---|
614 | /* The last call_info (for functions) structure
|
---|
615 | seen so it can be associated with fixups and
|
---|
616 | function labels. */
|
---|
617 | static struct call_info *last_call_info;
|
---|
618 |
|
---|
619 | /* The last call description (for actual calls). */
|
---|
620 | static struct call_desc last_call_desc;
|
---|
621 |
|
---|
622 | /* handle of the OPCODE hash table */
|
---|
623 | static struct hash_control *op_hash = NULL;
|
---|
624 |
|
---|
625 | /* Table of pseudo ops for the PA. FIXME -- how many of these
|
---|
626 | are now redundant with the overall GAS and the object file
|
---|
627 | dependent tables? */
|
---|
628 | const pseudo_typeS md_pseudo_table[] =
|
---|
629 | {
|
---|
630 | /* align pseudo-ops on the PA specify the actual alignment requested,
|
---|
631 | not the log2 of the requested alignment. */
|
---|
632 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
633 | {"align", pa_align, 8},
|
---|
634 | #endif
|
---|
635 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
636 | {"align", s_align_bytes, 8},
|
---|
637 | #endif
|
---|
638 | {"begin_brtab", pa_brtab, 1},
|
---|
639 | {"begin_try", pa_try, 1},
|
---|
640 | {"block", pa_block, 1},
|
---|
641 | {"blockz", pa_block, 0},
|
---|
642 | {"byte", pa_cons, 1},
|
---|
643 | {"call", pa_call, 0},
|
---|
644 | {"callinfo", pa_callinfo, 0},
|
---|
645 | #if defined (OBJ_ELF) && defined (TE_LINUX)
|
---|
646 | {"code", obj_elf_text, 0},
|
---|
647 | #else
|
---|
648 | {"code", pa_text, 0},
|
---|
649 | {"comm", pa_comm, 0},
|
---|
650 | #endif
|
---|
651 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
652 | {"compiler", pa_compiler, 0},
|
---|
653 | #endif
|
---|
654 | {"copyright", pa_copyright, 0},
|
---|
655 | #if !(defined (OBJ_ELF) && defined (TE_LINUX))
|
---|
656 | {"data", pa_data, 0},
|
---|
657 | #endif
|
---|
658 | {"double", pa_float_cons, 'd'},
|
---|
659 | {"dword", pa_cons, 8},
|
---|
660 | {"end", pa_end, 0},
|
---|
661 | {"end_brtab", pa_brtab, 0},
|
---|
662 | #if !(defined (OBJ_ELF) && defined (TE_LINUX))
|
---|
663 | {"end_try", pa_try, 0},
|
---|
664 | #endif
|
---|
665 | {"enter", pa_enter, 0},
|
---|
666 | {"entry", pa_entry, 0},
|
---|
667 | {"equ", pa_equ, 0},
|
---|
668 | {"exit", pa_exit, 0},
|
---|
669 | {"export", pa_export, 0},
|
---|
670 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
671 | {"file", (void (*) PARAMS ((int))) dwarf2_directive_file, 0 },
|
---|
672 | #endif
|
---|
673 | {"fill", pa_fill, 0},
|
---|
674 | {"float", pa_float_cons, 'f'},
|
---|
675 | {"half", pa_cons, 2},
|
---|
676 | {"import", pa_import, 0},
|
---|
677 | {"int", pa_cons, 4},
|
---|
678 | {"label", pa_label, 0},
|
---|
679 | {"lcomm", pa_lcomm, 0},
|
---|
680 | {"leave", pa_leave, 0},
|
---|
681 | {"level", pa_level, 0},
|
---|
682 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
683 | {"loc", dwarf2_directive_loc, 0 },
|
---|
684 | #endif
|
---|
685 | {"long", pa_cons, 4},
|
---|
686 | {"lsym", pa_lsym, 0},
|
---|
687 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
688 | {"nsubspa", pa_subspace, 1},
|
---|
689 | #endif
|
---|
690 | {"octa", pa_cons, 16},
|
---|
691 | {"org", pa_origin, 0},
|
---|
692 | {"origin", pa_origin, 0},
|
---|
693 | {"param", pa_param, 0},
|
---|
694 | {"proc", pa_proc, 0},
|
---|
695 | {"procend", pa_procend, 0},
|
---|
696 | {"quad", pa_cons, 8},
|
---|
697 | {"reg", pa_equ, 1},
|
---|
698 | {"short", pa_cons, 2},
|
---|
699 | {"single", pa_float_cons, 'f'},
|
---|
700 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
701 | {"space", pa_space, 0},
|
---|
702 | {"spnum", pa_spnum, 0},
|
---|
703 | #endif
|
---|
704 | {"string", pa_stringer, 0},
|
---|
705 | {"stringz", pa_stringer, 1},
|
---|
706 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
707 | {"subspa", pa_subspace, 0},
|
---|
708 | #endif
|
---|
709 | #if !(defined (OBJ_ELF) && defined (TE_LINUX))
|
---|
710 | {"text", pa_text, 0},
|
---|
711 | #endif
|
---|
712 | {"version", pa_version, 0},
|
---|
713 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
714 | {"vtable_entry", pa_vtable_entry, 0},
|
---|
715 | {"vtable_inherit", pa_vtable_inherit, 0},
|
---|
716 | #endif
|
---|
717 | {"word", pa_cons, 4},
|
---|
718 | {NULL, 0, 0}
|
---|
719 | };
|
---|
720 |
|
---|
721 | /* This array holds the chars that only start a comment at the beginning of
|
---|
722 | a line. If the line seems to have the form '# 123 filename'
|
---|
723 | .line and .file directives will appear in the pre-processed output.
|
---|
724 |
|
---|
725 | Note that input_file.c hand checks for '#' at the beginning of the
|
---|
726 | first line of the input file. This is because the compiler outputs
|
---|
727 | #NO_APP at the beginning of its output.
|
---|
728 |
|
---|
729 | Also note that C style comments will always work. */
|
---|
730 | const char line_comment_chars[] = "#";
|
---|
731 |
|
---|
732 | /* This array holds the chars that always start a comment. If the
|
---|
733 | pre-processor is disabled, these aren't very useful. */
|
---|
734 | const char comment_chars[] = ";";
|
---|
735 |
|
---|
736 | /* This array holds the characters which act as line separators. */
|
---|
737 | const char line_separator_chars[] = "!";
|
---|
738 |
|
---|
739 | /* Chars that can be used to separate mant from exp in floating point nums. */
|
---|
740 | const char EXP_CHARS[] = "eE";
|
---|
741 |
|
---|
742 | /* Chars that mean this number is a floating point constant.
|
---|
743 | As in 0f12.456 or 0d1.2345e12.
|
---|
744 |
|
---|
745 | Be aware that MAXIMUM_NUMBER_OF_CHARS_FOR_FLOAT may have to be
|
---|
746 | changed in read.c. Ideally it shouldn't hae to know abou it at
|
---|
747 | all, but nothing is ideal around here. */
|
---|
748 | const char FLT_CHARS[] = "rRsSfFdDxXpP";
|
---|
749 |
|
---|
750 | static struct pa_it the_insn;
|
---|
751 |
|
---|
752 | /* Points to the end of an expression just parsed by get_expressoin
|
---|
753 | and friends. FIXME. This shouldn't be handled with a file-global
|
---|
754 | variable. */
|
---|
755 | static char *expr_end;
|
---|
756 |
|
---|
757 | /* Nonzero if a .callinfo appeared within the current procedure. */
|
---|
758 | static int callinfo_found;
|
---|
759 |
|
---|
760 | /* Nonzero if the assembler is currently within a .entry/.exit pair. */
|
---|
761 | static int within_entry_exit;
|
---|
762 |
|
---|
763 | /* Nonzero if the assembler is currently within a procedure definition. */
|
---|
764 | static int within_procedure;
|
---|
765 |
|
---|
766 | /* Handle on structure which keep track of the last symbol
|
---|
767 | seen in each subspace. */
|
---|
768 | static label_symbol_struct *label_symbols_rootp = NULL;
|
---|
769 |
|
---|
770 | /* Holds the last field selector. */
|
---|
771 | static int hppa_field_selector;
|
---|
772 |
|
---|
773 | /* Nonzero when strict syntax checking is enabled. Zero otherwise.
|
---|
774 |
|
---|
775 | Each opcode in the table has a flag which indicates whether or not
|
---|
776 | strict syntax checking should be enabled for that instruction. */
|
---|
777 | static int strict = 0;
|
---|
778 |
|
---|
779 | /* pa_parse_number returns values in `pa_number'. Mostly
|
---|
780 | pa_parse_number is used to return a register number, with floating
|
---|
781 | point registers being numbered from FP_REG_BASE upwards.
|
---|
782 | The bit specified with FP_REG_RSEL is set if the floating point
|
---|
783 | register has a `r' suffix. */
|
---|
784 | #define FP_REG_BASE 64
|
---|
785 | #define FP_REG_RSEL 128
|
---|
786 | static int pa_number;
|
---|
787 |
|
---|
788 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
789 | /* A dummy bfd symbol so that all relocations have symbols of some kind. */
|
---|
790 | static symbolS *dummy_symbol;
|
---|
791 | #endif
|
---|
792 |
|
---|
793 | /* Nonzero if errors are to be printed. */
|
---|
794 | static int print_errors = 1;
|
---|
795 |
|
---|
796 | /* List of registers that are pre-defined:
|
---|
797 |
|
---|
798 | Each general register has one predefined name of the form
|
---|
799 | %r<REGNUM> which has the value <REGNUM>.
|
---|
800 |
|
---|
801 | Space and control registers are handled in a similar manner,
|
---|
802 | but use %sr<REGNUM> and %cr<REGNUM> as their predefined names.
|
---|
803 |
|
---|
804 | Likewise for the floating point registers, but of the form
|
---|
805 | %fr<REGNUM>. Floating point registers have additional predefined
|
---|
806 | names with 'L' and 'R' suffixes (e.g. %fr19L, %fr19R) which
|
---|
807 | again have the value <REGNUM>.
|
---|
808 |
|
---|
809 | Many registers also have synonyms:
|
---|
810 |
|
---|
811 | %r26 - %r23 have %arg0 - %arg3 as synonyms
|
---|
812 | %r28 - %r29 have %ret0 - %ret1 as synonyms
|
---|
813 | %r30 has %sp as a synonym
|
---|
814 | %r27 has %dp as a synonym
|
---|
815 | %r2 has %rp as a synonym
|
---|
816 |
|
---|
817 | Almost every control register has a synonym; they are not listed
|
---|
818 | here for brevity.
|
---|
819 |
|
---|
820 | The table is sorted. Suitable for searching by a binary search. */
|
---|
821 |
|
---|
822 | static const struct pd_reg pre_defined_registers[] =
|
---|
823 | {
|
---|
824 | {"%arg0", 26},
|
---|
825 | {"%arg1", 25},
|
---|
826 | {"%arg2", 24},
|
---|
827 | {"%arg3", 23},
|
---|
828 | {"%cr0", 0},
|
---|
829 | {"%cr10", 10},
|
---|
830 | {"%cr11", 11},
|
---|
831 | {"%cr12", 12},
|
---|
832 | {"%cr13", 13},
|
---|
833 | {"%cr14", 14},
|
---|
834 | {"%cr15", 15},
|
---|
835 | {"%cr16", 16},
|
---|
836 | {"%cr17", 17},
|
---|
837 | {"%cr18", 18},
|
---|
838 | {"%cr19", 19},
|
---|
839 | {"%cr20", 20},
|
---|
840 | {"%cr21", 21},
|
---|
841 | {"%cr22", 22},
|
---|
842 | {"%cr23", 23},
|
---|
843 | {"%cr24", 24},
|
---|
844 | {"%cr25", 25},
|
---|
845 | {"%cr26", 26},
|
---|
846 | {"%cr27", 27},
|
---|
847 | {"%cr28", 28},
|
---|
848 | {"%cr29", 29},
|
---|
849 | {"%cr30", 30},
|
---|
850 | {"%cr31", 31},
|
---|
851 | {"%cr8", 8},
|
---|
852 | {"%cr9", 9},
|
---|
853 | {"%dp", 27},
|
---|
854 | {"%eiem", 15},
|
---|
855 | {"%eirr", 23},
|
---|
856 | {"%fr0", 0 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
857 | {"%fr0l", 0 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
858 | {"%fr0r", 0 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
859 | {"%fr1", 1 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
860 | {"%fr10", 10 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
861 | {"%fr10l", 10 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
862 | {"%fr10r", 10 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
863 | {"%fr11", 11 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
864 | {"%fr11l", 11 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
865 | {"%fr11r", 11 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
866 | {"%fr12", 12 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
867 | {"%fr12l", 12 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
868 | {"%fr12r", 12 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
869 | {"%fr13", 13 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
870 | {"%fr13l", 13 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
871 | {"%fr13r", 13 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
872 | {"%fr14", 14 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
873 | {"%fr14l", 14 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
874 | {"%fr14r", 14 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
875 | {"%fr15", 15 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
876 | {"%fr15l", 15 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
877 | {"%fr15r", 15 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
878 | {"%fr16", 16 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
879 | {"%fr16l", 16 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
880 | {"%fr16r", 16 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
881 | {"%fr17", 17 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
882 | {"%fr17l", 17 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
883 | {"%fr17r", 17 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
884 | {"%fr18", 18 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
885 | {"%fr18l", 18 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
886 | {"%fr18r", 18 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
887 | {"%fr19", 19 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
888 | {"%fr19l", 19 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
889 | {"%fr19r", 19 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
890 | {"%fr1l", 1 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
891 | {"%fr1r", 1 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
892 | {"%fr2", 2 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
893 | {"%fr20", 20 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
894 | {"%fr20l", 20 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
895 | {"%fr20r", 20 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
896 | {"%fr21", 21 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
897 | {"%fr21l", 21 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
898 | {"%fr21r", 21 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
899 | {"%fr22", 22 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
900 | {"%fr22l", 22 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
901 | {"%fr22r", 22 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
902 | {"%fr23", 23 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
903 | {"%fr23l", 23 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
904 | {"%fr23r", 23 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
905 | {"%fr24", 24 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
906 | {"%fr24l", 24 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
907 | {"%fr24r", 24 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
908 | {"%fr25", 25 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
909 | {"%fr25l", 25 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
910 | {"%fr25r", 25 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
911 | {"%fr26", 26 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
912 | {"%fr26l", 26 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
913 | {"%fr26r", 26 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
914 | {"%fr27", 27 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
915 | {"%fr27l", 27 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
916 | {"%fr27r", 27 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
917 | {"%fr28", 28 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
918 | {"%fr28l", 28 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
919 | {"%fr28r", 28 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
920 | {"%fr29", 29 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
921 | {"%fr29l", 29 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
922 | {"%fr29r", 29 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
923 | {"%fr2l", 2 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
924 | {"%fr2r", 2 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
925 | {"%fr3", 3 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
926 | {"%fr30", 30 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
927 | {"%fr30l", 30 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
928 | {"%fr30r", 30 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
929 | {"%fr31", 31 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
930 | {"%fr31l", 31 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
931 | {"%fr31r", 31 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
932 | {"%fr3l", 3 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
933 | {"%fr3r", 3 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
934 | {"%fr4", 4 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
935 | {"%fr4l", 4 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
936 | {"%fr4r", 4 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
937 | {"%fr5", 5 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
938 | {"%fr5l", 5 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
939 | {"%fr5r", 5 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
940 | {"%fr6", 6 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
941 | {"%fr6l", 6 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
942 | {"%fr6r", 6 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
943 | {"%fr7", 7 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
944 | {"%fr7l", 7 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
945 | {"%fr7r", 7 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
946 | {"%fr8", 8 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
947 | {"%fr8l", 8 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
948 | {"%fr8r", 8 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
949 | {"%fr9", 9 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
950 | {"%fr9l", 9 + FP_REG_BASE},
|
---|
951 | {"%fr9r", 9 + FP_REG_BASE + FP_REG_RSEL},
|
---|
952 | {"%hta", 25},
|
---|
953 | {"%iir", 19},
|
---|
954 | {"%ior", 21},
|
---|
955 | {"%ipsw", 22},
|
---|
956 | {"%isr", 20},
|
---|
957 | {"%itmr", 16},
|
---|
958 | {"%iva", 14},
|
---|
959 | #if TARGET_ARCH_SIZE == 64
|
---|
960 | {"%mrp", 2},
|
---|
961 | #else
|
---|
962 | {"%mrp", 31},
|
---|
963 | #endif
|
---|
964 | {"%pcoq", 18},
|
---|
965 | {"%pcsq", 17},
|
---|
966 | {"%pidr1", 8},
|
---|
967 | {"%pidr2", 9},
|
---|
968 | {"%pidr3", 12},
|
---|
969 | {"%pidr4", 13},
|
---|
970 | {"%ppda", 24},
|
---|
971 | {"%r0", 0},
|
---|
972 | {"%r1", 1},
|
---|
973 | {"%r10", 10},
|
---|
974 | {"%r11", 11},
|
---|
975 | {"%r12", 12},
|
---|
976 | {"%r13", 13},
|
---|
977 | {"%r14", 14},
|
---|
978 | {"%r15", 15},
|
---|
979 | {"%r16", 16},
|
---|
980 | {"%r17", 17},
|
---|
981 | {"%r18", 18},
|
---|
982 | {"%r19", 19},
|
---|
983 | {"%r2", 2},
|
---|
984 | {"%r20", 20},
|
---|
985 | {"%r21", 21},
|
---|
986 | {"%r22", 22},
|
---|
987 | {"%r23", 23},
|
---|
988 | {"%r24", 24},
|
---|
989 | {"%r25", 25},
|
---|
990 | {"%r26", 26},
|
---|
991 | {"%r27", 27},
|
---|
992 | {"%r28", 28},
|
---|
993 | {"%r29", 29},
|
---|
994 | {"%r3", 3},
|
---|
995 | {"%r30", 30},
|
---|
996 | {"%r31", 31},
|
---|
997 | {"%r4", 4},
|
---|
998 | {"%r5", 5},
|
---|
999 | {"%r6", 6},
|
---|
1000 | {"%r7", 7},
|
---|
1001 | {"%r8", 8},
|
---|
1002 | {"%r9", 9},
|
---|
1003 | {"%rctr", 0},
|
---|
1004 | {"%ret0", 28},
|
---|
1005 | {"%ret1", 29},
|
---|
1006 | {"%rp", 2},
|
---|
1007 | {"%sar", 11},
|
---|
1008 | {"%sp", 30},
|
---|
1009 | {"%sr0", 0},
|
---|
1010 | {"%sr1", 1},
|
---|
1011 | {"%sr2", 2},
|
---|
1012 | {"%sr3", 3},
|
---|
1013 | {"%sr4", 4},
|
---|
1014 | {"%sr5", 5},
|
---|
1015 | {"%sr6", 6},
|
---|
1016 | {"%sr7", 7},
|
---|
1017 | {"%tr0", 24},
|
---|
1018 | {"%tr1", 25},
|
---|
1019 | {"%tr2", 26},
|
---|
1020 | {"%tr3", 27},
|
---|
1021 | {"%tr4", 28},
|
---|
1022 | {"%tr5", 29},
|
---|
1023 | {"%tr6", 30},
|
---|
1024 | {"%tr7", 31}
|
---|
1025 | };
|
---|
1026 |
|
---|
1027 | /* This table is sorted by order of the length of the string. This is
|
---|
1028 | so we check for <> before we check for <. If we had a <> and checked
|
---|
1029 | for < first, we would get a false match. */
|
---|
1030 | static const struct fp_cond_map fp_cond_map[] =
|
---|
1031 | {
|
---|
1032 | {"false?", 0},
|
---|
1033 | {"false", 1},
|
---|
1034 | {"true?", 30},
|
---|
1035 | {"true", 31},
|
---|
1036 | {"!<=>", 3},
|
---|
1037 | {"!?>=", 8},
|
---|
1038 | {"!?<=", 16},
|
---|
1039 | {"!<>", 7},
|
---|
1040 | {"!>=", 11},
|
---|
1041 | {"!?>", 12},
|
---|
1042 | {"?<=", 14},
|
---|
1043 | {"!<=", 19},
|
---|
1044 | {"!?<", 20},
|
---|
1045 | {"?>=", 22},
|
---|
1046 | {"!?=", 24},
|
---|
1047 | {"!=t", 27},
|
---|
1048 | {"<=>", 29},
|
---|
1049 | {"=t", 5},
|
---|
1050 | {"?=", 6},
|
---|
1051 | {"?<", 10},
|
---|
1052 | {"<=", 13},
|
---|
1053 | {"!>", 15},
|
---|
1054 | {"?>", 18},
|
---|
1055 | {">=", 21},
|
---|
1056 | {"!<", 23},
|
---|
1057 | {"<>", 25},
|
---|
1058 | {"!=", 26},
|
---|
1059 | {"!?", 28},
|
---|
1060 | {"?", 2},
|
---|
1061 | {"=", 4},
|
---|
1062 | {"<", 9},
|
---|
1063 | {">", 17}
|
---|
1064 | };
|
---|
1065 |
|
---|
1066 | static const struct selector_entry selector_table[] =
|
---|
1067 | {
|
---|
1068 | {"f", e_fsel},
|
---|
1069 | {"l", e_lsel},
|
---|
1070 | {"ld", e_ldsel},
|
---|
1071 | {"lp", e_lpsel},
|
---|
1072 | {"lr", e_lrsel},
|
---|
1073 | {"ls", e_lssel},
|
---|
1074 | {"lt", e_ltsel},
|
---|
1075 | {"ltp", e_ltpsel},
|
---|
1076 | {"n", e_nsel},
|
---|
1077 | {"nl", e_nlsel},
|
---|
1078 | {"nlr", e_nlrsel},
|
---|
1079 | {"p", e_psel},
|
---|
1080 | {"r", e_rsel},
|
---|
1081 | {"rd", e_rdsel},
|
---|
1082 | {"rp", e_rpsel},
|
---|
1083 | {"rr", e_rrsel},
|
---|
1084 | {"rs", e_rssel},
|
---|
1085 | {"rt", e_rtsel},
|
---|
1086 | {"rtp", e_rtpsel},
|
---|
1087 | {"t", e_tsel},
|
---|
1088 | };
|
---|
1089 |
|
---|
1090 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1091 | /* default space and subspace dictionaries */
|
---|
1092 |
|
---|
1093 | #define GDB_SYMBOLS GDB_SYMBOLS_SUBSPACE_NAME
|
---|
1094 | #define GDB_STRINGS GDB_STRINGS_SUBSPACE_NAME
|
---|
1095 |
|
---|
1096 | /* pre-defined subsegments (subspaces) for the HPPA. */
|
---|
1097 | #define SUBSEG_CODE 0
|
---|
1098 | #define SUBSEG_LIT 1
|
---|
1099 | #define SUBSEG_MILLI 2
|
---|
1100 | #define SUBSEG_DATA 0
|
---|
1101 | #define SUBSEG_BSS 2
|
---|
1102 | #define SUBSEG_UNWIND 3
|
---|
1103 | #define SUBSEG_GDB_STRINGS 0
|
---|
1104 | #define SUBSEG_GDB_SYMBOLS 1
|
---|
1105 |
|
---|
1106 | static struct default_subspace_dict pa_def_subspaces[] =
|
---|
1107 | {
|
---|
1108 | {"$CODE$", 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 24, 0x2c, 0, 8, 0, 0, SUBSEG_CODE},
|
---|
1109 | {"$DATA$", 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 24, 0x1f, 1, 8, 1, 1, SUBSEG_DATA},
|
---|
1110 | {"$LIT$", 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 16, 0x2c, 0, 8, 0, 0, SUBSEG_LIT},
|
---|
1111 | {"$MILLICODE$", 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 8, 0x2c, 0, 8, 0, 0, SUBSEG_MILLI},
|
---|
1112 | {"$BSS$", 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 80, 0x1f, 1, 8, 1, 1, SUBSEG_BSS},
|
---|
1113 | {NULL, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 255, 0x1f, 0, 4, 0, 0, 0}
|
---|
1114 | };
|
---|
1115 |
|
---|
1116 | static struct default_space_dict pa_def_spaces[] =
|
---|
1117 | {
|
---|
1118 | {"$TEXT$", 0, 1, 1, 0, 8, ASEC_NULL},
|
---|
1119 | {"$PRIVATE$", 1, 1, 1, 1, 16, ASEC_NULL},
|
---|
1120 | {NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, ASEC_NULL}
|
---|
1121 | };
|
---|
1122 |
|
---|
1123 | /* Misc local definitions used by the assembler. */
|
---|
1124 |
|
---|
1125 | /* These macros are used to maintain spaces/subspaces. */
|
---|
1126 | #define SPACE_DEFINED(space_chain) (space_chain)->sd_defined
|
---|
1127 | #define SPACE_USER_DEFINED(space_chain) (space_chain)->sd_user_defined
|
---|
1128 | #define SPACE_SPNUM(space_chain) (space_chain)->sd_spnum
|
---|
1129 | #define SPACE_NAME(space_chain) (space_chain)->sd_name
|
---|
1130 |
|
---|
1131 | #define SUBSPACE_DEFINED(ss_chain) (ss_chain)->ssd_defined
|
---|
1132 | #define SUBSPACE_NAME(ss_chain) (ss_chain)->ssd_name
|
---|
1133 | #endif
|
---|
1134 |
|
---|
1135 | /* Return nonzero if the string pointed to by S potentially represents
|
---|
1136 | a right or left half of a FP register */
|
---|
1137 | #define IS_R_SELECT(S) (*(S) == 'R' || *(S) == 'r')
|
---|
1138 | #define IS_L_SELECT(S) (*(S) == 'L' || *(S) == 'l')
|
---|
1139 |
|
---|
1140 | /* Insert FIELD into OPCODE starting at bit START. Continue pa_ip
|
---|
1141 | main loop after insertion. */
|
---|
1142 |
|
---|
1143 | #define INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE(OPCODE, FIELD, START) \
|
---|
1144 | { \
|
---|
1145 | ((OPCODE) |= (FIELD) << (START)); \
|
---|
1146 | continue; \
|
---|
1147 | }
|
---|
1148 |
|
---|
1149 | /* Simple range checking for FIELD againt HIGH and LOW bounds.
|
---|
1150 | IGNORE is used to suppress the error message. */
|
---|
1151 |
|
---|
1152 | #define CHECK_FIELD(FIELD, HIGH, LOW, IGNORE) \
|
---|
1153 | { \
|
---|
1154 | if ((FIELD) > (HIGH) || (FIELD) < (LOW)) \
|
---|
1155 | { \
|
---|
1156 | if (! IGNORE) \
|
---|
1157 | as_bad (_("Field out of range [%d..%d] (%d)."), (LOW), (HIGH), \
|
---|
1158 | (int) (FIELD));\
|
---|
1159 | break; \
|
---|
1160 | } \
|
---|
1161 | }
|
---|
1162 |
|
---|
1163 | /* Variant of CHECK_FIELD for use in md_apply_fix3 and other places where
|
---|
1164 | the current file and line number are not valid. */
|
---|
1165 |
|
---|
1166 | #define CHECK_FIELD_WHERE(FIELD, HIGH, LOW, FILENAME, LINE) \
|
---|
1167 | { \
|
---|
1168 | if ((FIELD) > (HIGH) || (FIELD) < (LOW)) \
|
---|
1169 | { \
|
---|
1170 | as_bad_where ((FILENAME), (LINE), \
|
---|
1171 | _("Field out of range [%d..%d] (%d)."), (LOW), (HIGH), \
|
---|
1172 | (int) (FIELD));\
|
---|
1173 | break; \
|
---|
1174 | } \
|
---|
1175 | }
|
---|
1176 |
|
---|
1177 | /* Simple alignment checking for FIELD againt ALIGN (a power of two).
|
---|
1178 | IGNORE is used to suppress the error message. */
|
---|
1179 |
|
---|
1180 | #define CHECK_ALIGN(FIELD, ALIGN, IGNORE) \
|
---|
1181 | { \
|
---|
1182 | if ((FIELD) & ((ALIGN) - 1)) \
|
---|
1183 | { \
|
---|
1184 | if (! IGNORE) \
|
---|
1185 | as_bad (_("Field not properly aligned [%d] (%d)."), (ALIGN), \
|
---|
1186 | (int) (FIELD));\
|
---|
1187 | break; \
|
---|
1188 | } \
|
---|
1189 | }
|
---|
1190 |
|
---|
1191 | #define is_DP_relative(exp) \
|
---|
1192 | ((exp).X_op == O_subtract \
|
---|
1193 | && strcmp (S_GET_NAME ((exp).X_op_symbol), "$global$") == 0)
|
---|
1194 |
|
---|
1195 | #define is_PC_relative(exp) \
|
---|
1196 | ((exp).X_op == O_subtract \
|
---|
1197 | && strcmp (S_GET_NAME ((exp).X_op_symbol), "$PIC_pcrel$0") == 0)
|
---|
1198 |
|
---|
1199 | /* We need some complex handling for stabs (sym1 - sym2). Luckily, we'll
|
---|
1200 | always be able to reduce the expression to a constant, so we don't
|
---|
1201 | need real complex handling yet. */
|
---|
1202 | #define is_complex(exp) \
|
---|
1203 | ((exp).X_op != O_constant && (exp).X_op != O_symbol)
|
---|
1204 |
|
---|
1205 | /* Actual functions to implement the PA specific code for the assembler. */
|
---|
1206 |
|
---|
1207 | /* Called before writing the object file. Make sure entry/exit and
|
---|
1208 | proc/procend pairs match. */
|
---|
1209 |
|
---|
1210 | void
|
---|
1211 | pa_check_eof ()
|
---|
1212 | {
|
---|
1213 | if (within_entry_exit)
|
---|
1214 | as_fatal (_("Missing .exit\n"));
|
---|
1215 |
|
---|
1216 | if (within_procedure)
|
---|
1217 | as_fatal (_("Missing .procend\n"));
|
---|
1218 | }
|
---|
1219 |
|
---|
1220 | /* Returns a pointer to the label_symbol_struct for the current space.
|
---|
1221 | or NULL if no label_symbol_struct exists for the current space. */
|
---|
1222 |
|
---|
1223 | static label_symbol_struct *
|
---|
1224 | pa_get_label ()
|
---|
1225 | {
|
---|
1226 | label_symbol_struct *label_chain;
|
---|
1227 |
|
---|
1228 | for (label_chain = label_symbols_rootp;
|
---|
1229 | label_chain;
|
---|
1230 | label_chain = label_chain->lss_next)
|
---|
1231 | {
|
---|
1232 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1233 | if (current_space == label_chain->lss_space && label_chain->lss_label)
|
---|
1234 | return label_chain;
|
---|
1235 | #endif
|
---|
1236 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
1237 | if (now_seg == label_chain->lss_segment && label_chain->lss_label)
|
---|
1238 | return label_chain;
|
---|
1239 | #endif
|
---|
1240 | }
|
---|
1241 |
|
---|
1242 | return NULL;
|
---|
1243 | }
|
---|
1244 |
|
---|
1245 | /* Defines a label for the current space. If one is already defined,
|
---|
1246 | this function will replace it with the new label. */
|
---|
1247 |
|
---|
1248 | void
|
---|
1249 | pa_define_label (symbol)
|
---|
1250 | symbolS *symbol;
|
---|
1251 | {
|
---|
1252 | label_symbol_struct *label_chain = pa_get_label ();
|
---|
1253 |
|
---|
1254 | if (label_chain)
|
---|
1255 | label_chain->lss_label = symbol;
|
---|
1256 | else
|
---|
1257 | {
|
---|
1258 | /* Create a new label entry and add it to the head of the chain. */
|
---|
1259 | label_chain
|
---|
1260 | = (label_symbol_struct *) xmalloc (sizeof (label_symbol_struct));
|
---|
1261 | label_chain->lss_label = symbol;
|
---|
1262 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1263 | label_chain->lss_space = current_space;
|
---|
1264 | #endif
|
---|
1265 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
1266 | label_chain->lss_segment = now_seg;
|
---|
1267 | #endif
|
---|
1268 | label_chain->lss_next = NULL;
|
---|
1269 |
|
---|
1270 | if (label_symbols_rootp)
|
---|
1271 | label_chain->lss_next = label_symbols_rootp;
|
---|
1272 |
|
---|
1273 | label_symbols_rootp = label_chain;
|
---|
1274 | }
|
---|
1275 | }
|
---|
1276 |
|
---|
1277 | /* Removes a label definition for the current space.
|
---|
1278 | If there is no label_symbol_struct entry, then no action is taken. */
|
---|
1279 |
|
---|
1280 | static void
|
---|
1281 | pa_undefine_label ()
|
---|
1282 | {
|
---|
1283 | label_symbol_struct *label_chain;
|
---|
1284 | label_symbol_struct *prev_label_chain = NULL;
|
---|
1285 |
|
---|
1286 | for (label_chain = label_symbols_rootp;
|
---|
1287 | label_chain;
|
---|
1288 | label_chain = label_chain->lss_next)
|
---|
1289 | {
|
---|
1290 | if (1
|
---|
1291 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1292 | && current_space == label_chain->lss_space && label_chain->lss_label
|
---|
1293 | #endif
|
---|
1294 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
1295 | && now_seg == label_chain->lss_segment && label_chain->lss_label
|
---|
1296 | #endif
|
---|
1297 | )
|
---|
1298 | {
|
---|
1299 | /* Remove the label from the chain and free its memory. */
|
---|
1300 | if (prev_label_chain)
|
---|
1301 | prev_label_chain->lss_next = label_chain->lss_next;
|
---|
1302 | else
|
---|
1303 | label_symbols_rootp = label_chain->lss_next;
|
---|
1304 |
|
---|
1305 | free (label_chain);
|
---|
1306 | break;
|
---|
1307 | }
|
---|
1308 | prev_label_chain = label_chain;
|
---|
1309 | }
|
---|
1310 | }
|
---|
1311 |
|
---|
1312 | /* An HPPA-specific version of fix_new. This is required because the HPPA
|
---|
1313 | code needs to keep track of some extra stuff. Each call to fix_new_hppa
|
---|
1314 | results in the creation of an instance of an hppa_fix_struct. An
|
---|
1315 | hppa_fix_struct stores the extra information along with a pointer to the
|
---|
1316 | original fixS. This is attached to the original fixup via the
|
---|
1317 | tc_fix_data field. */
|
---|
1318 |
|
---|
1319 | static void
|
---|
1320 | fix_new_hppa (frag, where, size, add_symbol, offset, exp, pcrel,
|
---|
1321 | r_type, r_field, r_format, arg_reloc, unwind_bits)
|
---|
1322 | fragS *frag;
|
---|
1323 | int where;
|
---|
1324 | int size;
|
---|
1325 | symbolS *add_symbol;
|
---|
1326 | offsetT offset;
|
---|
1327 | expressionS *exp;
|
---|
1328 | int pcrel;
|
---|
1329 | bfd_reloc_code_real_type r_type;
|
---|
1330 | enum hppa_reloc_field_selector_type_alt r_field;
|
---|
1331 | int r_format;
|
---|
1332 | unsigned int arg_reloc;
|
---|
1333 | int unwind_bits ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
1334 | {
|
---|
1335 | fixS *new_fix;
|
---|
1336 |
|
---|
1337 | struct hppa_fix_struct *hppa_fix = (struct hppa_fix_struct *)
|
---|
1338 | obstack_alloc (¬es, sizeof (struct hppa_fix_struct));
|
---|
1339 |
|
---|
1340 | if (exp != NULL)
|
---|
1341 | new_fix = fix_new_exp (frag, where, size, exp, pcrel, r_type);
|
---|
1342 | else
|
---|
1343 | new_fix = fix_new (frag, where, size, add_symbol, offset, pcrel, r_type);
|
---|
1344 | new_fix->tc_fix_data = (void *) hppa_fix;
|
---|
1345 | hppa_fix->fx_r_type = r_type;
|
---|
1346 | hppa_fix->fx_r_field = r_field;
|
---|
1347 | hppa_fix->fx_r_format = r_format;
|
---|
1348 | hppa_fix->fx_arg_reloc = arg_reloc;
|
---|
1349 | hppa_fix->segment = now_seg;
|
---|
1350 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1351 | if (r_type == R_ENTRY || r_type == R_EXIT)
|
---|
1352 | new_fix->fx_offset = unwind_bits;
|
---|
1353 | #endif
|
---|
1354 |
|
---|
1355 | /* foo-$global$ is used to access non-automatic storage. $global$
|
---|
1356 | is really just a marker and has served its purpose, so eliminate
|
---|
1357 | it now so as not to confuse write.c. Ditto for $PIC_pcrel$0. */
|
---|
1358 | if (new_fix->fx_subsy
|
---|
1359 | && (strcmp (S_GET_NAME (new_fix->fx_subsy), "$global$") == 0
|
---|
1360 | || strcmp (S_GET_NAME (new_fix->fx_subsy), "$PIC_pcrel$0") == 0))
|
---|
1361 | new_fix->fx_subsy = NULL;
|
---|
1362 | }
|
---|
1363 |
|
---|
1364 | /* Parse a .byte, .word, .long expression for the HPPA. Called by
|
---|
1365 | cons via the TC_PARSE_CONS_EXPRESSION macro. */
|
---|
1366 |
|
---|
1367 | void
|
---|
1368 | parse_cons_expression_hppa (exp)
|
---|
1369 | expressionS *exp;
|
---|
1370 | {
|
---|
1371 | hppa_field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&input_line_pointer);
|
---|
1372 | expression (exp);
|
---|
1373 | }
|
---|
1374 |
|
---|
1375 | /* This fix_new is called by cons via TC_CONS_FIX_NEW.
|
---|
1376 | hppa_field_selector is set by the parse_cons_expression_hppa. */
|
---|
1377 |
|
---|
1378 | void
|
---|
1379 | cons_fix_new_hppa (frag, where, size, exp)
|
---|
1380 | fragS *frag;
|
---|
1381 | int where;
|
---|
1382 | int size;
|
---|
1383 | expressionS *exp;
|
---|
1384 | {
|
---|
1385 | unsigned int rel_type;
|
---|
1386 |
|
---|
1387 | /* Get a base relocation type. */
|
---|
1388 | if (is_DP_relative (*exp))
|
---|
1389 | rel_type = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
1390 | else if (is_complex (*exp))
|
---|
1391 | rel_type = R_HPPA_COMPLEX;
|
---|
1392 | else
|
---|
1393 | rel_type = R_HPPA;
|
---|
1394 |
|
---|
1395 | if (hppa_field_selector != e_psel && hppa_field_selector != e_fsel)
|
---|
1396 | {
|
---|
1397 | as_warn (_("Invalid field selector. Assuming F%%."));
|
---|
1398 | hppa_field_selector = e_fsel;
|
---|
1399 | }
|
---|
1400 |
|
---|
1401 | fix_new_hppa (frag, where, size,
|
---|
1402 | (symbolS *) NULL, (offsetT) 0, exp, 0, rel_type,
|
---|
1403 | hppa_field_selector, size * 8, 0, 0);
|
---|
1404 |
|
---|
1405 | /* Reset field selector to its default state. */
|
---|
1406 | hppa_field_selector = 0;
|
---|
1407 | }
|
---|
1408 |
|
---|
1409 | /* This function is called once, at assembler startup time. It should
|
---|
1410 | set up all the tables, etc. that the MD part of the assembler will need. */
|
---|
1411 |
|
---|
1412 | void
|
---|
1413 | md_begin ()
|
---|
1414 | {
|
---|
1415 | const char *retval = NULL;
|
---|
1416 | int lose = 0;
|
---|
1417 | unsigned int i = 0;
|
---|
1418 |
|
---|
1419 | last_call_info = NULL;
|
---|
1420 | call_info_root = NULL;
|
---|
1421 |
|
---|
1422 | /* Set the default machine type. */
|
---|
1423 | if (!bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_hppa, DEFAULT_LEVEL))
|
---|
1424 | as_warn (_("could not set architecture and machine"));
|
---|
1425 |
|
---|
1426 | /* Folding of text and data segments fails miserably on the PA.
|
---|
1427 | Warn user and disable "-R" option. */
|
---|
1428 | if (flag_readonly_data_in_text)
|
---|
1429 | {
|
---|
1430 | as_warn (_("-R option not supported on this target."));
|
---|
1431 | flag_readonly_data_in_text = 0;
|
---|
1432 | }
|
---|
1433 |
|
---|
1434 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1435 | pa_spaces_begin ();
|
---|
1436 | #endif
|
---|
1437 |
|
---|
1438 | op_hash = hash_new ();
|
---|
1439 |
|
---|
1440 | while (i < NUMOPCODES)
|
---|
1441 | {
|
---|
1442 | const char *name = pa_opcodes[i].name;
|
---|
1443 | retval = hash_insert (op_hash, name, (struct pa_opcode *) &pa_opcodes[i]);
|
---|
1444 | if (retval != NULL && *retval != '\0')
|
---|
1445 | {
|
---|
1446 | as_fatal (_("Internal error: can't hash `%s': %s\n"), name, retval);
|
---|
1447 | lose = 1;
|
---|
1448 | }
|
---|
1449 | do
|
---|
1450 | {
|
---|
1451 | if ((pa_opcodes[i].match & pa_opcodes[i].mask)
|
---|
1452 | != pa_opcodes[i].match)
|
---|
1453 | {
|
---|
1454 | fprintf (stderr, _("internal error: losing opcode: `%s' \"%s\"\n"),
|
---|
1455 | pa_opcodes[i].name, pa_opcodes[i].args);
|
---|
1456 | lose = 1;
|
---|
1457 | }
|
---|
1458 | ++i;
|
---|
1459 | }
|
---|
1460 | while (i < NUMOPCODES && !strcmp (pa_opcodes[i].name, name));
|
---|
1461 | }
|
---|
1462 |
|
---|
1463 | if (lose)
|
---|
1464 | as_fatal (_("Broken assembler. No assembly attempted."));
|
---|
1465 |
|
---|
1466 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1467 | /* SOM will change text_section. To make sure we never put
|
---|
1468 | anything into the old one switch to the new one now. */
|
---|
1469 | subseg_set (text_section, 0);
|
---|
1470 | #endif
|
---|
1471 |
|
---|
1472 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1473 | dummy_symbol = symbol_find_or_make ("L$dummy");
|
---|
1474 | S_SET_SEGMENT (dummy_symbol, text_section);
|
---|
1475 | /* Force the symbol to be converted to a real symbol. */
|
---|
1476 | (void) symbol_get_bfdsym (dummy_symbol);
|
---|
1477 | #endif
|
---|
1478 | }
|
---|
1479 |
|
---|
1480 | /* Assemble a single instruction storing it into a frag. */
|
---|
1481 | void
|
---|
1482 | md_assemble (str)
|
---|
1483 | char *str;
|
---|
1484 | {
|
---|
1485 | char *to;
|
---|
1486 |
|
---|
1487 | /* The had better be something to assemble. */
|
---|
1488 | assert (str);
|
---|
1489 |
|
---|
1490 | /* If we are within a procedure definition, make sure we've
|
---|
1491 | defined a label for the procedure; handle case where the
|
---|
1492 | label was defined after the .PROC directive.
|
---|
1493 |
|
---|
1494 | Note there's not need to diddle with the segment or fragment
|
---|
1495 | for the label symbol in this case. We have already switched
|
---|
1496 | into the new $CODE$ subspace at this point. */
|
---|
1497 | if (within_procedure && last_call_info->start_symbol == NULL)
|
---|
1498 | {
|
---|
1499 | label_symbol_struct *label_symbol = pa_get_label ();
|
---|
1500 |
|
---|
1501 | if (label_symbol)
|
---|
1502 | {
|
---|
1503 | if (label_symbol->lss_label)
|
---|
1504 | {
|
---|
1505 | last_call_info->start_symbol = label_symbol->lss_label;
|
---|
1506 | symbol_get_bfdsym (label_symbol->lss_label)->flags
|
---|
1507 | |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
1508 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1509 | /* Also handle allocation of a fixup to hold the unwind
|
---|
1510 | information when the label appears after the proc/procend. */
|
---|
1511 | if (within_entry_exit)
|
---|
1512 | {
|
---|
1513 | char *where;
|
---|
1514 | unsigned int u;
|
---|
1515 |
|
---|
1516 | where = frag_more (0);
|
---|
1517 | u = UNWIND_LOW32 (&last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor);
|
---|
1518 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, where - frag_now->fr_literal, 0,
|
---|
1519 | NULL, (offsetT) 0, NULL,
|
---|
1520 | 0, R_HPPA_ENTRY, e_fsel, 0, 0, u);
|
---|
1521 | }
|
---|
1522 | #endif
|
---|
1523 | }
|
---|
1524 | else
|
---|
1525 | as_bad (_("Missing function name for .PROC (corrupted label chain)"));
|
---|
1526 | }
|
---|
1527 | else
|
---|
1528 | as_bad (_("Missing function name for .PROC"));
|
---|
1529 | }
|
---|
1530 |
|
---|
1531 | /* Assemble the instruction. Results are saved into "the_insn". */
|
---|
1532 | pa_ip (str);
|
---|
1533 |
|
---|
1534 | /* Get somewhere to put the assembled instrution. */
|
---|
1535 | to = frag_more (4);
|
---|
1536 |
|
---|
1537 | /* Output the opcode. */
|
---|
1538 | md_number_to_chars (to, the_insn.opcode, 4);
|
---|
1539 |
|
---|
1540 | /* If necessary output more stuff. */
|
---|
1541 | if (the_insn.reloc != R_HPPA_NONE)
|
---|
1542 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, (to - frag_now->fr_literal), 4, NULL,
|
---|
1543 | (offsetT) 0, &the_insn.exp, the_insn.pcrel,
|
---|
1544 | the_insn.reloc, the_insn.field_selector,
|
---|
1545 | the_insn.format, the_insn.arg_reloc, 0);
|
---|
1546 |
|
---|
1547 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
1548 | dwarf2_emit_insn (4);
|
---|
1549 | #endif
|
---|
1550 | }
|
---|
1551 |
|
---|
1552 | /* Do the real work for assembling a single instruction. Store results
|
---|
1553 | into the global "the_insn" variable. */
|
---|
1554 |
|
---|
1555 | static void
|
---|
1556 | pa_ip (str)
|
---|
1557 | char *str;
|
---|
1558 | {
|
---|
1559 | char *error_message = "";
|
---|
1560 | char *s, c, *argstart, *name, *save_s;
|
---|
1561 | const char *args;
|
---|
1562 | int match = FALSE;
|
---|
1563 | int comma = 0;
|
---|
1564 | int cmpltr, nullif, flag, cond, num;
|
---|
1565 | unsigned long opcode;
|
---|
1566 | struct pa_opcode *insn;
|
---|
1567 |
|
---|
1568 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
1569 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
1570 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
1571 | #endif
|
---|
1572 |
|
---|
1573 | /* Convert everything up to the first whitespace character into lower
|
---|
1574 | case. */
|
---|
1575 | for (s = str; *s != ' ' && *s != '\t' && *s != '\n' && *s != '\0'; s++)
|
---|
1576 | *s = TOLOWER (*s);
|
---|
1577 |
|
---|
1578 | /* Skip to something interesting. */
|
---|
1579 | for (s = str;
|
---|
1580 | ISUPPER (*s) || ISLOWER (*s) || (*s >= '0' && *s <= '3');
|
---|
1581 | ++s)
|
---|
1582 | ;
|
---|
1583 |
|
---|
1584 | switch (*s)
|
---|
1585 | {
|
---|
1586 |
|
---|
1587 | case '\0':
|
---|
1588 | break;
|
---|
1589 |
|
---|
1590 | case ',':
|
---|
1591 | comma = 1;
|
---|
1592 |
|
---|
1593 | /*FALLTHROUGH */
|
---|
1594 |
|
---|
1595 | case ' ':
|
---|
1596 | *s++ = '\0';
|
---|
1597 | break;
|
---|
1598 |
|
---|
1599 | default:
|
---|
1600 | as_fatal (_("Unknown opcode: `%s'"), str);
|
---|
1601 | }
|
---|
1602 |
|
---|
1603 | /* Look up the opcode in the has table. */
|
---|
1604 | if ((insn = (struct pa_opcode *) hash_find (op_hash, str)) == NULL)
|
---|
1605 | {
|
---|
1606 | as_bad ("Unknown opcode: `%s'", str);
|
---|
1607 | return;
|
---|
1608 | }
|
---|
1609 |
|
---|
1610 | if (comma)
|
---|
1611 | {
|
---|
1612 | *--s = ',';
|
---|
1613 | }
|
---|
1614 |
|
---|
1615 | /* Mark the location where arguments for the instruction start, then
|
---|
1616 | start processing them. */
|
---|
1617 | argstart = s;
|
---|
1618 | for (;;)
|
---|
1619 | {
|
---|
1620 | /* Do some initialization. */
|
---|
1621 | opcode = insn->match;
|
---|
1622 | strict = (insn->flags & FLAG_STRICT);
|
---|
1623 | memset (&the_insn, 0, sizeof (the_insn));
|
---|
1624 |
|
---|
1625 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_NONE;
|
---|
1626 |
|
---|
1627 | /* If this instruction is specific to a particular architecture,
|
---|
1628 | then set a new architecture. */
|
---|
1629 | /* But do not automatically promote to pa2.0. The automatic promotion
|
---|
1630 | crud is for compatability with HP's old assemblers only. */
|
---|
1631 | if (insn->arch < 20
|
---|
1632 | && bfd_get_mach (stdoutput) < insn->arch)
|
---|
1633 | {
|
---|
1634 | if (!bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_hppa, insn->arch))
|
---|
1635 | as_warn (_("could not update architecture and machine"));
|
---|
1636 | }
|
---|
1637 | else if (bfd_get_mach (stdoutput) < insn->arch)
|
---|
1638 | {
|
---|
1639 | match = FALSE;
|
---|
1640 | goto failed;
|
---|
1641 | }
|
---|
1642 |
|
---|
1643 | /* Build the opcode, checking as we go to make
|
---|
1644 | sure that the operands match. */
|
---|
1645 | for (args = insn->args;; ++args)
|
---|
1646 | {
|
---|
1647 | /* Absorb white space in instruction. */
|
---|
1648 | while (*s == ' ' || *s == '\t')
|
---|
1649 | s++;
|
---|
1650 |
|
---|
1651 | switch (*args)
|
---|
1652 | {
|
---|
1653 |
|
---|
1654 | /* End of arguments. */
|
---|
1655 | case '\0':
|
---|
1656 | if (*s == '\0')
|
---|
1657 | match = TRUE;
|
---|
1658 | break;
|
---|
1659 |
|
---|
1660 | case '+':
|
---|
1661 | if (*s == '+')
|
---|
1662 | {
|
---|
1663 | ++s;
|
---|
1664 | continue;
|
---|
1665 | }
|
---|
1666 | if (*s == '-')
|
---|
1667 | continue;
|
---|
1668 | break;
|
---|
1669 |
|
---|
1670 | /* These must match exactly. */
|
---|
1671 | case '(':
|
---|
1672 | case ')':
|
---|
1673 | case ',':
|
---|
1674 | case ' ':
|
---|
1675 | if (*s++ == *args)
|
---|
1676 | continue;
|
---|
1677 | break;
|
---|
1678 |
|
---|
1679 | /* Handle a 5 bit register or control register field at 10. */
|
---|
1680 | case 'b':
|
---|
1681 | case '^':
|
---|
1682 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 0))
|
---|
1683 | break;
|
---|
1684 | num = pa_number;
|
---|
1685 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
1686 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 21);
|
---|
1687 |
|
---|
1688 | /* Handle %sar or %cr11. No bits get set, we just verify that it
|
---|
1689 | is there. */
|
---|
1690 | case '!':
|
---|
1691 | /* Skip whitespace before register. */
|
---|
1692 | while (*s == ' ' || *s == '\t')
|
---|
1693 | s = s + 1;
|
---|
1694 |
|
---|
1695 | if (!strncasecmp (s, "%sar", 4))
|
---|
1696 | {
|
---|
1697 | s += 4;
|
---|
1698 | continue;
|
---|
1699 | }
|
---|
1700 | else if (!strncasecmp (s, "%cr11", 5))
|
---|
1701 | {
|
---|
1702 | s += 5;
|
---|
1703 | continue;
|
---|
1704 | }
|
---|
1705 | break;
|
---|
1706 |
|
---|
1707 | /* Handle a 5 bit register field at 15. */
|
---|
1708 | case 'x':
|
---|
1709 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 0))
|
---|
1710 | break;
|
---|
1711 | num = pa_number;
|
---|
1712 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
1713 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 16);
|
---|
1714 |
|
---|
1715 | /* Handle a 5 bit register field at 31. */
|
---|
1716 | case 't':
|
---|
1717 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 0))
|
---|
1718 | break;
|
---|
1719 | num = pa_number;
|
---|
1720 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
1721 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
1722 |
|
---|
1723 | /* Handle a 5 bit register field at 10 and 15. */
|
---|
1724 | case 'a':
|
---|
1725 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 0))
|
---|
1726 | break;
|
---|
1727 | num = pa_number;
|
---|
1728 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
1729 | opcode |= num << 16;
|
---|
1730 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 21);
|
---|
1731 |
|
---|
1732 | /* Handle a 5 bit field length at 31. */
|
---|
1733 | case 'T':
|
---|
1734 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
1735 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
1736 | break;
|
---|
1737 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
1738 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 32, 1, 0);
|
---|
1739 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, 32 - num, 0);
|
---|
1740 |
|
---|
1741 | /* Handle a 5 bit immediate at 15. */
|
---|
1742 | case '5':
|
---|
1743 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
1744 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
1745 | break;
|
---|
1746 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
1747 | /* When in strict mode, we want to just reject this
|
---|
1748 | match instead of giving an out of range error. */
|
---|
1749 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 15, -16, strict);
|
---|
1750 | num = low_sign_unext (num, 5);
|
---|
1751 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 16);
|
---|
1752 |
|
---|
1753 | /* Handle a 5 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
1754 | case 'V':
|
---|
1755 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
1756 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
1757 | break;
|
---|
1758 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
1759 | /* When in strict mode, we want to just reject this
|
---|
1760 | match instead of giving an out of range error. */
|
---|
1761 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 15, -16, strict);
|
---|
1762 | num = low_sign_unext (num, 5);
|
---|
1763 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
1764 |
|
---|
1765 | /* Handle an unsigned 5 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
1766 | case 'r':
|
---|
1767 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
1768 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
1769 | break;
|
---|
1770 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
1771 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, strict);
|
---|
1772 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
1773 |
|
---|
1774 | /* Handle an unsigned 5 bit immediate at 15. */
|
---|
1775 | case 'R':
|
---|
1776 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
1777 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
1778 | break;
|
---|
1779 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
1780 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, strict);
|
---|
1781 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 16);
|
---|
1782 |
|
---|
1783 | /* Handle an unsigned 10 bit immediate at 15. */
|
---|
1784 | case 'U':
|
---|
1785 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
1786 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
1787 | break;
|
---|
1788 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
1789 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 1023, 0, strict);
|
---|
1790 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 16);
|
---|
1791 |
|
---|
1792 | /* Handle a 2 bit space identifier at 17. */
|
---|
1793 | case 's':
|
---|
1794 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 0))
|
---|
1795 | break;
|
---|
1796 | num = pa_number;
|
---|
1797 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 3, 0, 1);
|
---|
1798 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 14);
|
---|
1799 |
|
---|
1800 | /* Handle a 3 bit space identifier at 18. */
|
---|
1801 | case 'S':
|
---|
1802 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 0))
|
---|
1803 | break;
|
---|
1804 | num = pa_number;
|
---|
1805 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 7, 0, 1);
|
---|
1806 | opcode |= re_assemble_3 (num);
|
---|
1807 | continue;
|
---|
1808 |
|
---|
1809 | /* Handle all completers. */
|
---|
1810 | case 'c':
|
---|
1811 | switch (*++args)
|
---|
1812 | {
|
---|
1813 |
|
---|
1814 | /* Handle a completer for an indexing load or store. */
|
---|
1815 | case 'X':
|
---|
1816 | case 'x':
|
---|
1817 | {
|
---|
1818 | int uu = 0;
|
---|
1819 | int m = 0;
|
---|
1820 | int i = 0;
|
---|
1821 | while (*s == ',' && i < 2)
|
---|
1822 | {
|
---|
1823 | s++;
|
---|
1824 | if (strncasecmp (s, "sm", 2) == 0)
|
---|
1825 | {
|
---|
1826 | uu = 1;
|
---|
1827 | m = 1;
|
---|
1828 | s++;
|
---|
1829 | i++;
|
---|
1830 | }
|
---|
1831 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "m", 1) == 0)
|
---|
1832 | m = 1;
|
---|
1833 | else if ((strncasecmp (s, "s ", 2) == 0)
|
---|
1834 | || (strncasecmp (s, "s,", 2) == 0))
|
---|
1835 | uu = 1;
|
---|
1836 | /* When in strict mode this is a match failure. */
|
---|
1837 | else if (strict)
|
---|
1838 | {
|
---|
1839 | s--;
|
---|
1840 | break;
|
---|
1841 | }
|
---|
1842 | else
|
---|
1843 | as_bad (_("Invalid Indexed Load Completer."));
|
---|
1844 | s++;
|
---|
1845 | i++;
|
---|
1846 | }
|
---|
1847 | if (i > 2)
|
---|
1848 | as_bad (_("Invalid Indexed Load Completer Syntax."));
|
---|
1849 | opcode |= m << 5;
|
---|
1850 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, uu, 13);
|
---|
1851 | }
|
---|
1852 |
|
---|
1853 | /* Handle a short load/store completer. */
|
---|
1854 | case 'M':
|
---|
1855 | case 'm':
|
---|
1856 | case 'q':
|
---|
1857 | case 'J':
|
---|
1858 | case 'e':
|
---|
1859 | {
|
---|
1860 | int a = 0;
|
---|
1861 | int m = 0;
|
---|
1862 | if (*s == ',')
|
---|
1863 | {
|
---|
1864 | int found = 0;
|
---|
1865 | s++;
|
---|
1866 | if (strncasecmp (s, "ma", 2) == 0)
|
---|
1867 | {
|
---|
1868 | a = 0;
|
---|
1869 | m = 1;
|
---|
1870 | found = 1;
|
---|
1871 | }
|
---|
1872 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "mb", 2) == 0)
|
---|
1873 | {
|
---|
1874 | a = 1;
|
---|
1875 | m = 1;
|
---|
1876 | found = 1;
|
---|
1877 | }
|
---|
1878 |
|
---|
1879 | /* When in strict mode, pass through for cache op. */
|
---|
1880 | if (!found && strict)
|
---|
1881 | s--;
|
---|
1882 | else
|
---|
1883 | {
|
---|
1884 | if (!found)
|
---|
1885 | as_bad (_("Invalid Short Load/Store Completer."));
|
---|
1886 | s += 2;
|
---|
1887 | }
|
---|
1888 | }
|
---|
1889 | /* If we did not get a ma/mb completer, then we do not
|
---|
1890 | consider this a positive match for 'ce'. */
|
---|
1891 | else if (*args == 'e')
|
---|
1892 | break;
|
---|
1893 |
|
---|
1894 | /* 'J', 'm', 'M' and 'q' are the same, except for where they
|
---|
1895 | encode the before/after field. */
|
---|
1896 | if (*args == 'm' || *args == 'M')
|
---|
1897 | {
|
---|
1898 | opcode |= m << 5;
|
---|
1899 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, a, 13);
|
---|
1900 | }
|
---|
1901 | else if (*args == 'q')
|
---|
1902 | {
|
---|
1903 | opcode |= m << 3;
|
---|
1904 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, a, 2);
|
---|
1905 | }
|
---|
1906 | else if (*args == 'J')
|
---|
1907 | {
|
---|
1908 | /* M bit is explicit in the major opcode. */
|
---|
1909 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, a, 2);
|
---|
1910 | }
|
---|
1911 | else if (*args == 'e')
|
---|
1912 | {
|
---|
1913 | /* Stash the ma/mb flag temporarily in the
|
---|
1914 | instruction. We will use (and remove it)
|
---|
1915 | later when handling 'J', 'K', '<' & '>'. */
|
---|
1916 | opcode |= a;
|
---|
1917 | continue;
|
---|
1918 | }
|
---|
1919 | }
|
---|
1920 |
|
---|
1921 | /* Handle a stbys completer. */
|
---|
1922 | case 'A':
|
---|
1923 | case 's':
|
---|
1924 | {
|
---|
1925 | int a = 0;
|
---|
1926 | int m = 0;
|
---|
1927 | int i = 0;
|
---|
1928 | while (*s == ',' && i < 2)
|
---|
1929 | {
|
---|
1930 | s++;
|
---|
1931 | if (strncasecmp (s, "m", 1) == 0)
|
---|
1932 | m = 1;
|
---|
1933 | else if ((strncasecmp (s, "b ", 2) == 0)
|
---|
1934 | || (strncasecmp (s, "b,", 2) == 0))
|
---|
1935 | a = 0;
|
---|
1936 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "e", 1) == 0)
|
---|
1937 | a = 1;
|
---|
1938 | /* When in strict mode this is a match failure. */
|
---|
1939 | else if (strict)
|
---|
1940 | {
|
---|
1941 | s--;
|
---|
1942 | break;
|
---|
1943 | }
|
---|
1944 | else
|
---|
1945 | as_bad (_("Invalid Store Bytes Short Completer"));
|
---|
1946 | s++;
|
---|
1947 | i++;
|
---|
1948 | }
|
---|
1949 | if (i > 2)
|
---|
1950 | as_bad (_("Invalid Store Bytes Short Completer"));
|
---|
1951 | opcode |= m << 5;
|
---|
1952 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, a, 13);
|
---|
1953 | }
|
---|
1954 |
|
---|
1955 | /* Handle load cache hint completer. */
|
---|
1956 | case 'c':
|
---|
1957 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
1958 | if (!strncmp (s, ",sl", 3))
|
---|
1959 | {
|
---|
1960 | s += 3;
|
---|
1961 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
1962 | }
|
---|
1963 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 10);
|
---|
1964 |
|
---|
1965 | /* Handle store cache hint completer. */
|
---|
1966 | case 'C':
|
---|
1967 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
1968 | if (!strncmp (s, ",sl", 3))
|
---|
1969 | {
|
---|
1970 | s += 3;
|
---|
1971 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
1972 | }
|
---|
1973 | else if (!strncmp (s, ",bc", 3))
|
---|
1974 | {
|
---|
1975 | s += 3;
|
---|
1976 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
1977 | }
|
---|
1978 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 10);
|
---|
1979 |
|
---|
1980 | /* Handle load and clear cache hint completer. */
|
---|
1981 | case 'd':
|
---|
1982 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
1983 | if (!strncmp (s, ",co", 3))
|
---|
1984 | {
|
---|
1985 | s += 3;
|
---|
1986 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
1987 | }
|
---|
1988 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 10);
|
---|
1989 |
|
---|
1990 | /* Handle load ordering completer. */
|
---|
1991 | case 'o':
|
---|
1992 | if (strncmp (s, ",o", 2) != 0)
|
---|
1993 | break;
|
---|
1994 | s += 2;
|
---|
1995 | continue;
|
---|
1996 |
|
---|
1997 | /* Handle a branch gate completer. */
|
---|
1998 | case 'g':
|
---|
1999 | if (strncasecmp (s, ",gate", 5) != 0)
|
---|
2000 | break;
|
---|
2001 | s += 5;
|
---|
2002 | continue;
|
---|
2003 |
|
---|
2004 | /* Handle a branch link and push completer. */
|
---|
2005 | case 'p':
|
---|
2006 | if (strncasecmp (s, ",l,push", 7) != 0)
|
---|
2007 | break;
|
---|
2008 | s += 7;
|
---|
2009 | continue;
|
---|
2010 |
|
---|
2011 | /* Handle a branch link completer. */
|
---|
2012 | case 'l':
|
---|
2013 | if (strncasecmp (s, ",l", 2) != 0)
|
---|
2014 | break;
|
---|
2015 | s += 2;
|
---|
2016 | continue;
|
---|
2017 |
|
---|
2018 | /* Handle a branch pop completer. */
|
---|
2019 | case 'P':
|
---|
2020 | if (strncasecmp (s, ",pop", 4) != 0)
|
---|
2021 | break;
|
---|
2022 | s += 4;
|
---|
2023 | continue;
|
---|
2024 |
|
---|
2025 | /* Handle a local processor completer. */
|
---|
2026 | case 'L':
|
---|
2027 | if (strncasecmp (s, ",l", 2) != 0)
|
---|
2028 | break;
|
---|
2029 | s += 2;
|
---|
2030 | continue;
|
---|
2031 |
|
---|
2032 | /* Handle a PROBE read/write completer. */
|
---|
2033 | case 'w':
|
---|
2034 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2035 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",w", 2))
|
---|
2036 | {
|
---|
2037 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2038 | s += 2;
|
---|
2039 | }
|
---|
2040 | else if (!strncasecmp (s, ",r", 2))
|
---|
2041 | {
|
---|
2042 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2043 | s += 2;
|
---|
2044 | }
|
---|
2045 |
|
---|
2046 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 6);
|
---|
2047 |
|
---|
2048 | /* Handle MFCTL wide completer. */
|
---|
2049 | case 'W':
|
---|
2050 | if (strncasecmp (s, ",w", 2) != 0)
|
---|
2051 | break;
|
---|
2052 | s += 2;
|
---|
2053 | continue;
|
---|
2054 |
|
---|
2055 | /* Handle an RFI restore completer. */
|
---|
2056 | case 'r':
|
---|
2057 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2058 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",r", 2))
|
---|
2059 | {
|
---|
2060 | flag = 5;
|
---|
2061 | s += 2;
|
---|
2062 | }
|
---|
2063 |
|
---|
2064 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 5);
|
---|
2065 |
|
---|
2066 | /* Handle a system control completer. */
|
---|
2067 | case 'Z':
|
---|
2068 | if (*s == ',' && (*(s + 1) == 'm' || *(s + 1) == 'M'))
|
---|
2069 | {
|
---|
2070 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2071 | s += 2;
|
---|
2072 | }
|
---|
2073 | else
|
---|
2074 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2075 |
|
---|
2076 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 5);
|
---|
2077 |
|
---|
2078 | /* Handle intermediate/final completer for DCOR. */
|
---|
2079 | case 'i':
|
---|
2080 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2081 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",i", 2))
|
---|
2082 | {
|
---|
2083 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2084 | s += 2;
|
---|
2085 | }
|
---|
2086 |
|
---|
2087 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 6);
|
---|
2088 |
|
---|
2089 | /* Handle zero/sign extension completer. */
|
---|
2090 | case 'z':
|
---|
2091 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2092 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",z", 2))
|
---|
2093 | {
|
---|
2094 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2095 | s += 2;
|
---|
2096 | }
|
---|
2097 |
|
---|
2098 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 10);
|
---|
2099 |
|
---|
2100 | /* Handle add completer. */
|
---|
2101 | case 'a':
|
---|
2102 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2103 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",l", 2))
|
---|
2104 | {
|
---|
2105 | flag = 2;
|
---|
2106 | s += 2;
|
---|
2107 | }
|
---|
2108 | else if (!strncasecmp (s, ",tsv", 4))
|
---|
2109 | {
|
---|
2110 | flag = 3;
|
---|
2111 | s += 4;
|
---|
2112 | }
|
---|
2113 |
|
---|
2114 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 10);
|
---|
2115 |
|
---|
2116 | /* Handle 64 bit carry for ADD. */
|
---|
2117 | case 'Y':
|
---|
2118 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2119 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",dc,tsv", 7) ||
|
---|
2120 | !strncasecmp (s, ",tsv,dc", 7))
|
---|
2121 | {
|
---|
2122 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2123 | s += 7;
|
---|
2124 | }
|
---|
2125 | else if (!strncasecmp (s, ",dc", 3))
|
---|
2126 | {
|
---|
2127 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2128 | s += 3;
|
---|
2129 | }
|
---|
2130 | else
|
---|
2131 | break;
|
---|
2132 |
|
---|
2133 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
2134 |
|
---|
2135 | /* Handle 32 bit carry for ADD. */
|
---|
2136 | case 'y':
|
---|
2137 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2138 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",c,tsv", 6) ||
|
---|
2139 | !strncasecmp (s, ",tsv,c", 6))
|
---|
2140 | {
|
---|
2141 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2142 | s += 6;
|
---|
2143 | }
|
---|
2144 | else if (!strncasecmp (s, ",c", 2))
|
---|
2145 | {
|
---|
2146 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2147 | s += 2;
|
---|
2148 | }
|
---|
2149 | else
|
---|
2150 | break;
|
---|
2151 |
|
---|
2152 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
2153 |
|
---|
2154 | /* Handle trap on signed overflow. */
|
---|
2155 | case 'v':
|
---|
2156 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2157 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",tsv", 4))
|
---|
2158 | {
|
---|
2159 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2160 | s += 4;
|
---|
2161 | }
|
---|
2162 |
|
---|
2163 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
2164 |
|
---|
2165 | /* Handle trap on condition and overflow. */
|
---|
2166 | case 't':
|
---|
2167 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2168 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",tc,tsv", 7) ||
|
---|
2169 | !strncasecmp (s, ",tsv,tc", 7))
|
---|
2170 | {
|
---|
2171 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2172 | s += 7;
|
---|
2173 | }
|
---|
2174 | else if (!strncasecmp (s, ",tc", 3))
|
---|
2175 | {
|
---|
2176 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2177 | s += 3;
|
---|
2178 | }
|
---|
2179 | else
|
---|
2180 | break;
|
---|
2181 |
|
---|
2182 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
2183 |
|
---|
2184 | /* Handle 64 bit borrow for SUB. */
|
---|
2185 | case 'B':
|
---|
2186 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2187 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",db,tsv", 7) ||
|
---|
2188 | !strncasecmp (s, ",tsv,db", 7))
|
---|
2189 | {
|
---|
2190 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2191 | s += 7;
|
---|
2192 | }
|
---|
2193 | else if (!strncasecmp (s, ",db", 3))
|
---|
2194 | {
|
---|
2195 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2196 | s += 3;
|
---|
2197 | }
|
---|
2198 | else
|
---|
2199 | break;
|
---|
2200 |
|
---|
2201 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
2202 |
|
---|
2203 | /* Handle 32 bit borrow for SUB. */
|
---|
2204 | case 'b':
|
---|
2205 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2206 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",b,tsv", 6) ||
|
---|
2207 | !strncasecmp (s, ",tsv,b", 6))
|
---|
2208 | {
|
---|
2209 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2210 | s += 6;
|
---|
2211 | }
|
---|
2212 | else if (!strncasecmp (s, ",b", 2))
|
---|
2213 | {
|
---|
2214 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2215 | s += 2;
|
---|
2216 | }
|
---|
2217 | else
|
---|
2218 | break;
|
---|
2219 |
|
---|
2220 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
2221 |
|
---|
2222 | /* Handle trap condition completer for UADDCM. */
|
---|
2223 | case 'T':
|
---|
2224 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2225 | if (!strncasecmp (s, ",tc", 3))
|
---|
2226 | {
|
---|
2227 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2228 | s += 3;
|
---|
2229 | }
|
---|
2230 |
|
---|
2231 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 6);
|
---|
2232 |
|
---|
2233 | /* Handle signed/unsigned at 21. */
|
---|
2234 | case 'S':
|
---|
2235 | {
|
---|
2236 | int sign = 1;
|
---|
2237 | if (strncasecmp (s, ",s", 2) == 0)
|
---|
2238 | {
|
---|
2239 | sign = 1;
|
---|
2240 | s += 2;
|
---|
2241 | }
|
---|
2242 | else if (strncasecmp (s, ",u", 2) == 0)
|
---|
2243 | {
|
---|
2244 | sign = 0;
|
---|
2245 | s += 2;
|
---|
2246 | }
|
---|
2247 |
|
---|
2248 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, sign, 10);
|
---|
2249 | }
|
---|
2250 |
|
---|
2251 | /* Handle left/right combination at 17:18. */
|
---|
2252 | case 'h':
|
---|
2253 | if (*s++ == ',')
|
---|
2254 | {
|
---|
2255 | int lr = 0;
|
---|
2256 | if (*s == 'r')
|
---|
2257 | lr = 2;
|
---|
2258 | else if (*s == 'l')
|
---|
2259 | lr = 0;
|
---|
2260 | else
|
---|
2261 | as_bad (_("Invalid left/right combination completer"));
|
---|
2262 |
|
---|
2263 | s++;
|
---|
2264 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, lr, 13);
|
---|
2265 | }
|
---|
2266 | else
|
---|
2267 | as_bad (_("Invalid left/right combination completer"));
|
---|
2268 | break;
|
---|
2269 |
|
---|
2270 | /* Handle saturation at 24:25. */
|
---|
2271 | case 'H':
|
---|
2272 | {
|
---|
2273 | int sat = 3;
|
---|
2274 | if (strncasecmp (s, ",ss", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2275 | {
|
---|
2276 | sat = 1;
|
---|
2277 | s += 3;
|
---|
2278 | }
|
---|
2279 | else if (strncasecmp (s, ",us", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2280 | {
|
---|
2281 | sat = 0;
|
---|
2282 | s += 3;
|
---|
2283 | }
|
---|
2284 |
|
---|
2285 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, sat, 6);
|
---|
2286 | }
|
---|
2287 |
|
---|
2288 | /* Handle permutation completer. */
|
---|
2289 | case '*':
|
---|
2290 | if (*s++ == ',')
|
---|
2291 | {
|
---|
2292 | int permloc[4];
|
---|
2293 | int perm = 0;
|
---|
2294 | int i = 0;
|
---|
2295 | permloc[0] = 13;
|
---|
2296 | permloc[1] = 10;
|
---|
2297 | permloc[2] = 8;
|
---|
2298 | permloc[3] = 6;
|
---|
2299 | for (; i < 4; i++)
|
---|
2300 | {
|
---|
2301 | switch (*s++)
|
---|
2302 | {
|
---|
2303 | case '0':
|
---|
2304 | perm = 0;
|
---|
2305 | break;
|
---|
2306 | case '1':
|
---|
2307 | perm = 1;
|
---|
2308 | break;
|
---|
2309 | case '2':
|
---|
2310 | perm = 2;
|
---|
2311 | break;
|
---|
2312 | case '3':
|
---|
2313 | perm = 3;
|
---|
2314 | break;
|
---|
2315 | default:
|
---|
2316 | as_bad (_("Invalid permutation completer"));
|
---|
2317 | }
|
---|
2318 | opcode |= perm << permloc[i];
|
---|
2319 | }
|
---|
2320 | continue;
|
---|
2321 | }
|
---|
2322 | else
|
---|
2323 | as_bad (_("Invalid permutation completer"));
|
---|
2324 | break;
|
---|
2325 |
|
---|
2326 | default:
|
---|
2327 | abort ();
|
---|
2328 | }
|
---|
2329 | break;
|
---|
2330 |
|
---|
2331 | /* Handle all conditions. */
|
---|
2332 | case '?':
|
---|
2333 | {
|
---|
2334 | args++;
|
---|
2335 | switch (*args)
|
---|
2336 | {
|
---|
2337 | /* Handle FP compare conditions. */
|
---|
2338 | case 'f':
|
---|
2339 | cond = pa_parse_fp_cmp_cond (&s);
|
---|
2340 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cond, 0);
|
---|
2341 |
|
---|
2342 | /* Handle an add condition. */
|
---|
2343 | case 'A':
|
---|
2344 | case 'a':
|
---|
2345 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2346 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2347 | if (*s == ',')
|
---|
2348 | {
|
---|
2349 | s++;
|
---|
2350 |
|
---|
2351 | /* 64 bit conditions. */
|
---|
2352 | if (*args == 'A')
|
---|
2353 | {
|
---|
2354 | if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2355 | s++;
|
---|
2356 | else
|
---|
2357 | break;
|
---|
2358 | }
|
---|
2359 | else if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2360 | break;
|
---|
2361 | name = s;
|
---|
2362 |
|
---|
2363 | name = s;
|
---|
2364 | while (*s != ',' && *s != ' ' && *s != '\t')
|
---|
2365 | s += 1;
|
---|
2366 | c = *s;
|
---|
2367 | *s = 0x00;
|
---|
2368 | if (strcmp (name, "=") == 0)
|
---|
2369 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2370 | else if (strcmp (name, "<") == 0)
|
---|
2371 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2372 | else if (strcmp (name, "<=") == 0)
|
---|
2373 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2374 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "nuv") == 0)
|
---|
2375 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
2376 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "znv") == 0)
|
---|
2377 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
2378 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "sv") == 0)
|
---|
2379 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
2380 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "od") == 0)
|
---|
2381 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2382 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "tr") == 0)
|
---|
2383 | {
|
---|
2384 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2385 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2386 | }
|
---|
2387 | else if (strcmp (name, "<>") == 0)
|
---|
2388 | {
|
---|
2389 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2390 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2391 | }
|
---|
2392 | else if (strcmp (name, ">=") == 0)
|
---|
2393 | {
|
---|
2394 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2395 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2396 | }
|
---|
2397 | else if (strcmp (name, ">") == 0)
|
---|
2398 | {
|
---|
2399 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2400 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2401 | }
|
---|
2402 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "uv") == 0)
|
---|
2403 | {
|
---|
2404 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
2405 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2406 | }
|
---|
2407 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "vnz") == 0)
|
---|
2408 | {
|
---|
2409 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
2410 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2411 | }
|
---|
2412 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "nsv") == 0)
|
---|
2413 | {
|
---|
2414 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
2415 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2416 | }
|
---|
2417 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "ev") == 0)
|
---|
2418 | {
|
---|
2419 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2420 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2421 | }
|
---|
2422 | /* ",*" is a valid condition. */
|
---|
2423 | else if (*args == 'a')
|
---|
2424 | as_bad (_("Invalid Add Condition: %s"), name);
|
---|
2425 | *s = c;
|
---|
2426 | }
|
---|
2427 | opcode |= cmpltr << 13;
|
---|
2428 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 12);
|
---|
2429 |
|
---|
2430 | /* Handle non-negated add and branch condition. */
|
---|
2431 | case 'd':
|
---|
2432 | cmpltr = pa_parse_nonneg_add_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2433 | if (cmpltr < 0)
|
---|
2434 | {
|
---|
2435 | as_bad (_("Invalid Add and Branch Condition"));
|
---|
2436 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2437 | }
|
---|
2438 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 13);
|
---|
2439 |
|
---|
2440 | /* Handle 64 bit wide-mode add and branch condition. */
|
---|
2441 | case 'W':
|
---|
2442 | cmpltr = pa_parse_addb_64_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2443 | if (cmpltr < 0)
|
---|
2444 | {
|
---|
2445 | as_bad (_("Invalid Add and Branch Condition"));
|
---|
2446 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2447 | }
|
---|
2448 | else
|
---|
2449 | {
|
---|
2450 | /* Negated condition requires an opcode change. */
|
---|
2451 | opcode |= (cmpltr & 8) << 24;
|
---|
2452 | }
|
---|
2453 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr & 7, 13);
|
---|
2454 |
|
---|
2455 | /* Handle a negated or non-negated add and branch
|
---|
2456 | condition. */
|
---|
2457 | case '@':
|
---|
2458 | save_s = s;
|
---|
2459 | cmpltr = pa_parse_nonneg_add_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2460 | if (cmpltr < 0)
|
---|
2461 | {
|
---|
2462 | s = save_s;
|
---|
2463 | cmpltr = pa_parse_neg_add_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2464 | if (cmpltr < 0)
|
---|
2465 | {
|
---|
2466 | as_bad (_("Invalid Compare/Subtract Condition"));
|
---|
2467 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2468 | }
|
---|
2469 | else
|
---|
2470 | {
|
---|
2471 | /* Negated condition requires an opcode change. */
|
---|
2472 | opcode |= 1 << 27;
|
---|
2473 | }
|
---|
2474 | }
|
---|
2475 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 13);
|
---|
2476 |
|
---|
2477 | /* Handle branch on bit conditions. */
|
---|
2478 | case 'B':
|
---|
2479 | case 'b':
|
---|
2480 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2481 | if (*s == ',')
|
---|
2482 | {
|
---|
2483 | s++;
|
---|
2484 |
|
---|
2485 | if (*args == 'B')
|
---|
2486 | {
|
---|
2487 | if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2488 | s++;
|
---|
2489 | else
|
---|
2490 | break;
|
---|
2491 | }
|
---|
2492 | else if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2493 | break;
|
---|
2494 |
|
---|
2495 | if (strncmp (s, "<", 1) == 0)
|
---|
2496 | {
|
---|
2497 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2498 | s++;
|
---|
2499 | }
|
---|
2500 | else if (strncmp (s, ">=", 2) == 0)
|
---|
2501 | {
|
---|
2502 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2503 | s += 2;
|
---|
2504 | }
|
---|
2505 | else
|
---|
2506 | as_bad (_("Invalid Bit Branch Condition: %c"), *s);
|
---|
2507 | }
|
---|
2508 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 15);
|
---|
2509 |
|
---|
2510 | /* Handle a compare/subtract condition. */
|
---|
2511 | case 'S':
|
---|
2512 | case 's':
|
---|
2513 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2514 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2515 | if (*s == ',')
|
---|
2516 | {
|
---|
2517 | s++;
|
---|
2518 |
|
---|
2519 | /* 64 bit conditions. */
|
---|
2520 | if (*args == 'S')
|
---|
2521 | {
|
---|
2522 | if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2523 | s++;
|
---|
2524 | else
|
---|
2525 | break;
|
---|
2526 | }
|
---|
2527 | else if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2528 | break;
|
---|
2529 | name = s;
|
---|
2530 |
|
---|
2531 | name = s;
|
---|
2532 | while (*s != ',' && *s != ' ' && *s != '\t')
|
---|
2533 | s += 1;
|
---|
2534 | c = *s;
|
---|
2535 | *s = 0x00;
|
---|
2536 | if (strcmp (name, "=") == 0)
|
---|
2537 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2538 | else if (strcmp (name, "<") == 0)
|
---|
2539 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2540 | else if (strcmp (name, "<=") == 0)
|
---|
2541 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2542 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "<<") == 0)
|
---|
2543 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
2544 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "<<=") == 0)
|
---|
2545 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
2546 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "sv") == 0)
|
---|
2547 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
2548 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "od") == 0)
|
---|
2549 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2550 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "tr") == 0)
|
---|
2551 | {
|
---|
2552 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2553 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2554 | }
|
---|
2555 | else if (strcmp (name, "<>") == 0)
|
---|
2556 | {
|
---|
2557 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2558 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2559 | }
|
---|
2560 | else if (strcmp (name, ">=") == 0)
|
---|
2561 | {
|
---|
2562 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2563 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2564 | }
|
---|
2565 | else if (strcmp (name, ">") == 0)
|
---|
2566 | {
|
---|
2567 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2568 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2569 | }
|
---|
2570 | else if (strcasecmp (name, ">>=") == 0)
|
---|
2571 | {
|
---|
2572 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
2573 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2574 | }
|
---|
2575 | else if (strcasecmp (name, ">>") == 0)
|
---|
2576 | {
|
---|
2577 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
2578 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2579 | }
|
---|
2580 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "nsv") == 0)
|
---|
2581 | {
|
---|
2582 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
2583 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2584 | }
|
---|
2585 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "ev") == 0)
|
---|
2586 | {
|
---|
2587 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2588 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2589 | }
|
---|
2590 | /* ",*" is a valid condition. */
|
---|
2591 | else if (*args != 'S')
|
---|
2592 | as_bad (_("Invalid Compare/Subtract Condition: %s"),
|
---|
2593 | name);
|
---|
2594 | *s = c;
|
---|
2595 | }
|
---|
2596 | opcode |= cmpltr << 13;
|
---|
2597 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 12);
|
---|
2598 |
|
---|
2599 | /* Handle a non-negated compare condition. */
|
---|
2600 | case 't':
|
---|
2601 | cmpltr = pa_parse_nonneg_cmpsub_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2602 | if (cmpltr < 0)
|
---|
2603 | {
|
---|
2604 | as_bad (_("Invalid Compare/Subtract Condition"));
|
---|
2605 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2606 | }
|
---|
2607 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 13);
|
---|
2608 |
|
---|
2609 | /* Handle a 32 bit compare and branch condition. */
|
---|
2610 | case 'n':
|
---|
2611 | save_s = s;
|
---|
2612 | cmpltr = pa_parse_nonneg_cmpsub_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2613 | if (cmpltr < 0)
|
---|
2614 | {
|
---|
2615 | s = save_s;
|
---|
2616 | cmpltr = pa_parse_neg_cmpsub_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2617 | if (cmpltr < 0)
|
---|
2618 | {
|
---|
2619 | as_bad (_("Invalid Compare and Branch Condition"));
|
---|
2620 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2621 | }
|
---|
2622 | else
|
---|
2623 | {
|
---|
2624 | /* Negated condition requires an opcode change. */
|
---|
2625 | opcode |= 1 << 27;
|
---|
2626 | }
|
---|
2627 | }
|
---|
2628 |
|
---|
2629 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 13);
|
---|
2630 |
|
---|
2631 | /* Handle a 64 bit compare and branch condition. */
|
---|
2632 | case 'N':
|
---|
2633 | cmpltr = pa_parse_cmpb_64_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2634 | if (cmpltr >= 0)
|
---|
2635 | {
|
---|
2636 | /* Negated condition requires an opcode change. */
|
---|
2637 | opcode |= (cmpltr & 8) << 26;
|
---|
2638 | }
|
---|
2639 | else
|
---|
2640 | /* Not a 64 bit cond. Give 32 bit a chance. */
|
---|
2641 | break;
|
---|
2642 |
|
---|
2643 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr & 7, 13);
|
---|
2644 |
|
---|
2645 | /* Handle a 64 bit cmpib condition. */
|
---|
2646 | case 'Q':
|
---|
2647 | cmpltr = pa_parse_cmpib_64_cmpltr (&s);
|
---|
2648 | if (cmpltr < 0)
|
---|
2649 | /* Not a 64 bit cond. Give 32 bit a chance. */
|
---|
2650 | break;
|
---|
2651 |
|
---|
2652 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 13);
|
---|
2653 |
|
---|
2654 | /* Handle a logical instruction condition. */
|
---|
2655 | case 'L':
|
---|
2656 | case 'l':
|
---|
2657 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2658 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2659 | if (*s == ',')
|
---|
2660 | {
|
---|
2661 | s++;
|
---|
2662 |
|
---|
2663 | /* 64 bit conditions. */
|
---|
2664 | if (*args == 'L')
|
---|
2665 | {
|
---|
2666 | if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2667 | s++;
|
---|
2668 | else
|
---|
2669 | break;
|
---|
2670 | }
|
---|
2671 | else if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2672 | break;
|
---|
2673 |
|
---|
2674 | name = s;
|
---|
2675 | while (*s != ',' && *s != ' ' && *s != '\t')
|
---|
2676 | s += 1;
|
---|
2677 | c = *s;
|
---|
2678 | *s = 0x00;
|
---|
2679 |
|
---|
2680 | if (strcmp (name, "=") == 0)
|
---|
2681 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2682 | else if (strcmp (name, "<") == 0)
|
---|
2683 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2684 | else if (strcmp (name, "<=") == 0)
|
---|
2685 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2686 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "od") == 0)
|
---|
2687 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2688 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "tr") == 0)
|
---|
2689 | {
|
---|
2690 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2691 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2692 | }
|
---|
2693 | else if (strcmp (name, "<>") == 0)
|
---|
2694 | {
|
---|
2695 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2696 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2697 | }
|
---|
2698 | else if (strcmp (name, ">=") == 0)
|
---|
2699 | {
|
---|
2700 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2701 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2702 | }
|
---|
2703 | else if (strcmp (name, ">") == 0)
|
---|
2704 | {
|
---|
2705 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2706 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2707 | }
|
---|
2708 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "ev") == 0)
|
---|
2709 | {
|
---|
2710 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2711 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2712 | }
|
---|
2713 | /* ",*" is a valid condition. */
|
---|
2714 | else if (*args != 'L')
|
---|
2715 | as_bad (_("Invalid Logical Instruction Condition."));
|
---|
2716 | *s = c;
|
---|
2717 | }
|
---|
2718 | opcode |= cmpltr << 13;
|
---|
2719 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 12);
|
---|
2720 |
|
---|
2721 | /* Handle a shift/extract/deposit condition. */
|
---|
2722 | case 'X':
|
---|
2723 | case 'x':
|
---|
2724 | case 'y':
|
---|
2725 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2726 | if (*s == ',')
|
---|
2727 | {
|
---|
2728 | save_s = s++;
|
---|
2729 |
|
---|
2730 | /* 64 bit conditions. */
|
---|
2731 | if (*args == 'X')
|
---|
2732 | {
|
---|
2733 | if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2734 | s++;
|
---|
2735 | else
|
---|
2736 | break;
|
---|
2737 | }
|
---|
2738 | else if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2739 | break;
|
---|
2740 |
|
---|
2741 | name = s;
|
---|
2742 | while (*s != ',' && *s != ' ' && *s != '\t')
|
---|
2743 | s += 1;
|
---|
2744 | c = *s;
|
---|
2745 | *s = 0x00;
|
---|
2746 | if (strcmp (name, "=") == 0)
|
---|
2747 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2748 | else if (strcmp (name, "<") == 0)
|
---|
2749 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2750 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "od") == 0)
|
---|
2751 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2752 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "tr") == 0)
|
---|
2753 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
2754 | else if (strcmp (name, "<>") == 0)
|
---|
2755 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
2756 | else if (strcmp (name, ">=") == 0)
|
---|
2757 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
2758 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "ev") == 0)
|
---|
2759 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2760 | /* Handle movb,n. Put things back the way they were.
|
---|
2761 | This includes moving s back to where it started. */
|
---|
2762 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "n") == 0 && *args == 'y')
|
---|
2763 | {
|
---|
2764 | *s = c;
|
---|
2765 | s = save_s;
|
---|
2766 | continue;
|
---|
2767 | }
|
---|
2768 | /* ",*" is a valid condition. */
|
---|
2769 | else if (*args != 'X')
|
---|
2770 | as_bad (_("Invalid Shift/Extract/Deposit Condition."));
|
---|
2771 | *s = c;
|
---|
2772 | }
|
---|
2773 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, cmpltr, 13);
|
---|
2774 |
|
---|
2775 | /* Handle a unit instruction condition. */
|
---|
2776 | case 'U':
|
---|
2777 | case 'u':
|
---|
2778 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2779 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2780 | if (*s == ',')
|
---|
2781 | {
|
---|
2782 | s++;
|
---|
2783 |
|
---|
2784 | /* 64 bit conditions. */
|
---|
2785 | if (*args == 'U')
|
---|
2786 | {
|
---|
2787 | if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2788 | s++;
|
---|
2789 | else
|
---|
2790 | break;
|
---|
2791 | }
|
---|
2792 | else if (*s == '*')
|
---|
2793 | break;
|
---|
2794 |
|
---|
2795 | if (strncasecmp (s, "sbz", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2796 | {
|
---|
2797 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2798 | s += 3;
|
---|
2799 | }
|
---|
2800 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "shz", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2801 | {
|
---|
2802 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2803 | s += 3;
|
---|
2804 | }
|
---|
2805 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "sdc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2806 | {
|
---|
2807 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
2808 | s += 3;
|
---|
2809 | }
|
---|
2810 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "sbc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2811 | {
|
---|
2812 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
2813 | s += 3;
|
---|
2814 | }
|
---|
2815 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "shc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2816 | {
|
---|
2817 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2818 | s += 3;
|
---|
2819 | }
|
---|
2820 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "tr", 2) == 0)
|
---|
2821 | {
|
---|
2822 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
2823 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2824 | s += 2;
|
---|
2825 | }
|
---|
2826 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "nbz", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2827 | {
|
---|
2828 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
2829 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2830 | s += 3;
|
---|
2831 | }
|
---|
2832 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "nhz", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2833 | {
|
---|
2834 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
2835 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2836 | s += 3;
|
---|
2837 | }
|
---|
2838 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "ndc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2839 | {
|
---|
2840 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
2841 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2842 | s += 3;
|
---|
2843 | }
|
---|
2844 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "nbc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2845 | {
|
---|
2846 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
2847 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2848 | s += 3;
|
---|
2849 | }
|
---|
2850 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "nhc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2851 | {
|
---|
2852 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
2853 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2854 | s += 3;
|
---|
2855 | }
|
---|
2856 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "swz", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2857 | {
|
---|
2858 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2859 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2860 | s += 3;
|
---|
2861 | }
|
---|
2862 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "swc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2863 | {
|
---|
2864 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
2865 | flag = 0;
|
---|
2866 | s += 3;
|
---|
2867 | }
|
---|
2868 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "nwz", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2869 | {
|
---|
2870 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
2871 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2872 | s += 3;
|
---|
2873 | }
|
---|
2874 | else if (strncasecmp (s, "nwc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2875 | {
|
---|
2876 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
2877 | flag = 1;
|
---|
2878 | s += 3;
|
---|
2879 | }
|
---|
2880 | /* ",*" is a valid condition. */
|
---|
2881 | else if (*args != 'U')
|
---|
2882 | as_bad (_("Invalid Unit Instruction Condition."));
|
---|
2883 | }
|
---|
2884 | opcode |= cmpltr << 13;
|
---|
2885 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 12);
|
---|
2886 |
|
---|
2887 | default:
|
---|
2888 | abort ();
|
---|
2889 | }
|
---|
2890 | break;
|
---|
2891 | }
|
---|
2892 |
|
---|
2893 | /* Handle a nullification completer for branch instructions. */
|
---|
2894 | case 'n':
|
---|
2895 | nullif = pa_parse_nullif (&s);
|
---|
2896 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, nullif, 1);
|
---|
2897 |
|
---|
2898 | /* Handle a nullification completer for copr and spop insns. */
|
---|
2899 | case 'N':
|
---|
2900 | nullif = pa_parse_nullif (&s);
|
---|
2901 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, nullif, 5);
|
---|
2902 |
|
---|
2903 | /* Handle ,%r2 completer for new syntax branches. */
|
---|
2904 | case 'L':
|
---|
2905 | if (*s == ',' && strncasecmp (s + 1, "%r2", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2906 | s += 4;
|
---|
2907 | else if (*s == ',' && strncasecmp (s + 1, "%rp", 3) == 0)
|
---|
2908 | s += 4;
|
---|
2909 | else
|
---|
2910 | break;
|
---|
2911 | continue;
|
---|
2912 |
|
---|
2913 | /* Handle 3 bit entry into the fp compare array. Valid values
|
---|
2914 | are 0..6 inclusive. */
|
---|
2915 | case 'h':
|
---|
2916 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
2917 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
2918 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
2919 | {
|
---|
2920 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
2921 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 6, 0, 0);
|
---|
2922 | num++;
|
---|
2923 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 13);
|
---|
2924 | }
|
---|
2925 | else
|
---|
2926 | break;
|
---|
2927 |
|
---|
2928 | /* Handle 3 bit entry into the fp compare array. Valid values
|
---|
2929 | are 0..6 inclusive. */
|
---|
2930 | case 'm':
|
---|
2931 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
2932 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
2933 | {
|
---|
2934 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
2935 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
2936 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 6, 0, 0);
|
---|
2937 | num = (num + 1) ^ 1;
|
---|
2938 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 13);
|
---|
2939 | }
|
---|
2940 | else
|
---|
2941 | break;
|
---|
2942 |
|
---|
2943 | /* Handle graphics test completers for ftest */
|
---|
2944 | case '=':
|
---|
2945 | {
|
---|
2946 | num = pa_parse_ftest_gfx_completer (&s);
|
---|
2947 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
2948 | }
|
---|
2949 |
|
---|
2950 | /* Handle a 11 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
2951 | case 'i':
|
---|
2952 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
2953 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
2954 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
2955 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
2956 | {
|
---|
2957 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
2958 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 1023, -1024, 0);
|
---|
2959 | num = low_sign_unext (num, 11);
|
---|
2960 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
2961 | }
|
---|
2962 | else
|
---|
2963 | {
|
---|
2964 | if (is_DP_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
2965 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
2966 | else if (is_PC_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
2967 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
2968 | else
|
---|
2969 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA;
|
---|
2970 | the_insn.format = 11;
|
---|
2971 | continue;
|
---|
2972 | }
|
---|
2973 |
|
---|
2974 | /* Handle a 14 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
2975 | case 'J':
|
---|
2976 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
2977 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
2978 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
2979 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
2980 | {
|
---|
2981 | int mb;
|
---|
2982 |
|
---|
2983 | /* XXX the completer stored away tidbits of information
|
---|
2984 | for us to extract. We need a cleaner way to do this.
|
---|
2985 | Now that we have lots of letters again, it would be
|
---|
2986 | good to rethink this. */
|
---|
2987 | mb = opcode & 1;
|
---|
2988 | opcode -= mb;
|
---|
2989 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
2990 | if (mb != (num < 0))
|
---|
2991 | break;
|
---|
2992 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 8191, -8192, 0);
|
---|
2993 | num = low_sign_unext (num, 14);
|
---|
2994 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
2995 | }
|
---|
2996 | break;
|
---|
2997 |
|
---|
2998 | /* Handle a 14 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
2999 | case 'K':
|
---|
3000 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3001 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3002 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3003 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3004 | {
|
---|
3005 | int mb;
|
---|
3006 |
|
---|
3007 | mb = opcode & 1;
|
---|
3008 | opcode -= mb;
|
---|
3009 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3010 | if (mb == (num < 0))
|
---|
3011 | break;
|
---|
3012 | if (num % 4)
|
---|
3013 | break;
|
---|
3014 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 8191, -8192, 0);
|
---|
3015 | num = low_sign_unext (num, 14);
|
---|
3016 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3017 | }
|
---|
3018 | break;
|
---|
3019 |
|
---|
3020 | /* Handle a 16 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
3021 | case '<':
|
---|
3022 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3023 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3024 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3025 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3026 | {
|
---|
3027 | int mb;
|
---|
3028 |
|
---|
3029 | mb = opcode & 1;
|
---|
3030 | opcode -= mb;
|
---|
3031 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3032 | if (mb != (num < 0))
|
---|
3033 | break;
|
---|
3034 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 32767, -32768, 0);
|
---|
3035 | num = re_assemble_16 (num);
|
---|
3036 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3037 | }
|
---|
3038 | break;
|
---|
3039 |
|
---|
3040 | /* Handle a 16 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
3041 | case '>':
|
---|
3042 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3043 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3044 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3045 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3046 | {
|
---|
3047 | int mb;
|
---|
3048 |
|
---|
3049 | mb = opcode & 1;
|
---|
3050 | opcode -= mb;
|
---|
3051 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3052 | if (mb == (num < 0))
|
---|
3053 | break;
|
---|
3054 | if (num % 4)
|
---|
3055 | break;
|
---|
3056 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 32767, -32768, 0);
|
---|
3057 | num = re_assemble_16 (num);
|
---|
3058 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3059 | }
|
---|
3060 | break;
|
---|
3061 |
|
---|
3062 | /* Handle 14 bit immediate, shifted left three times. */
|
---|
3063 | case '#':
|
---|
3064 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3065 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3066 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3067 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3068 | {
|
---|
3069 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3070 | if (num & 0x7)
|
---|
3071 | break;
|
---|
3072 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 8191, -8192, 0);
|
---|
3073 | if (num < 0)
|
---|
3074 | opcode |= 1;
|
---|
3075 | num &= 0x1fff;
|
---|
3076 | num >>= 3;
|
---|
3077 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 4);
|
---|
3078 | }
|
---|
3079 | else
|
---|
3080 | {
|
---|
3081 | if (is_DP_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3082 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
3083 | else if (is_PC_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3084 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3085 | else
|
---|
3086 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA;
|
---|
3087 | the_insn.format = 14;
|
---|
3088 | continue;
|
---|
3089 | }
|
---|
3090 | break;
|
---|
3091 |
|
---|
3092 | /* Handle 14 bit immediate, shifted left twice. */
|
---|
3093 | case 'd':
|
---|
3094 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3095 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3096 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3097 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3098 | {
|
---|
3099 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3100 | if (num & 0x3)
|
---|
3101 | break;
|
---|
3102 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 8191, -8192, 0);
|
---|
3103 | if (num < 0)
|
---|
3104 | opcode |= 1;
|
---|
3105 | num &= 0x1fff;
|
---|
3106 | num >>= 2;
|
---|
3107 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 3);
|
---|
3108 | }
|
---|
3109 | else
|
---|
3110 | {
|
---|
3111 | if (is_DP_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3112 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
3113 | else if (is_PC_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3114 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3115 | else
|
---|
3116 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA;
|
---|
3117 | the_insn.format = 14;
|
---|
3118 | continue;
|
---|
3119 | }
|
---|
3120 |
|
---|
3121 | /* Handle a 14 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
3122 | case 'j':
|
---|
3123 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3124 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3125 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3126 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3127 | {
|
---|
3128 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3129 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 8191, -8192, 0);
|
---|
3130 | num = low_sign_unext (num, 14);
|
---|
3131 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3132 | }
|
---|
3133 | else
|
---|
3134 | {
|
---|
3135 | if (is_DP_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3136 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
3137 | else if (is_PC_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3138 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3139 | else
|
---|
3140 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA;
|
---|
3141 | the_insn.format = 14;
|
---|
3142 | continue;
|
---|
3143 | }
|
---|
3144 |
|
---|
3145 | /* Handle a 21 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
3146 | case 'k':
|
---|
3147 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3148 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3149 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3150 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3151 | {
|
---|
3152 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3153 | CHECK_FIELD (num >> 11, 1048575, -1048576, 0);
|
---|
3154 | opcode |= re_assemble_21 (num);
|
---|
3155 | continue;
|
---|
3156 | }
|
---|
3157 | else
|
---|
3158 | {
|
---|
3159 | if (is_DP_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3160 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
3161 | else if (is_PC_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3162 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3163 | else
|
---|
3164 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA;
|
---|
3165 | the_insn.format = 21;
|
---|
3166 | continue;
|
---|
3167 | }
|
---|
3168 |
|
---|
3169 | /* Handle a 16 bit immediate at 31 (PA 2.0 wide mode only). */
|
---|
3170 | case 'l':
|
---|
3171 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3172 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3173 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3174 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3175 | {
|
---|
3176 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3177 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 32767, -32768, 0);
|
---|
3178 | opcode |= re_assemble_16 (num);
|
---|
3179 | continue;
|
---|
3180 | }
|
---|
3181 | else
|
---|
3182 | {
|
---|
3183 | /* ??? Is this valid for wide mode? */
|
---|
3184 | if (is_DP_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3185 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
3186 | else if (is_PC_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3187 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3188 | else
|
---|
3189 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA;
|
---|
3190 | the_insn.format = 14;
|
---|
3191 | continue;
|
---|
3192 | }
|
---|
3193 |
|
---|
3194 | /* Handle a word-aligned 16-bit imm. at 31 (PA2.0 wide). */
|
---|
3195 | case 'y':
|
---|
3196 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3197 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3198 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3199 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3200 | {
|
---|
3201 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3202 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 32767, -32768, 0);
|
---|
3203 | CHECK_ALIGN (num, 4, 0);
|
---|
3204 | opcode |= re_assemble_16 (num);
|
---|
3205 | continue;
|
---|
3206 | }
|
---|
3207 | else
|
---|
3208 | {
|
---|
3209 | /* ??? Is this valid for wide mode? */
|
---|
3210 | if (is_DP_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3211 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
3212 | else if (is_PC_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3213 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3214 | else
|
---|
3215 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA;
|
---|
3216 | the_insn.format = 14;
|
---|
3217 | continue;
|
---|
3218 | }
|
---|
3219 |
|
---|
3220 | /* Handle a dword-aligned 16-bit imm. at 31 (PA2.0 wide). */
|
---|
3221 | case '&':
|
---|
3222 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3223 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3224 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3225 | if (the_insn.exp.X_op == O_constant)
|
---|
3226 | {
|
---|
3227 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3228 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 32767, -32768, 0);
|
---|
3229 | CHECK_ALIGN (num, 8, 0);
|
---|
3230 | opcode |= re_assemble_16 (num);
|
---|
3231 | continue;
|
---|
3232 | }
|
---|
3233 | else
|
---|
3234 | {
|
---|
3235 | /* ??? Is this valid for wide mode? */
|
---|
3236 | if (is_DP_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3237 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_GOTOFF;
|
---|
3238 | else if (is_PC_relative (the_insn.exp))
|
---|
3239 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3240 | else
|
---|
3241 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA;
|
---|
3242 | the_insn.format = 14;
|
---|
3243 | continue;
|
---|
3244 | }
|
---|
3245 |
|
---|
3246 | /* Handle a 12 bit branch displacement. */
|
---|
3247 | case 'w':
|
---|
3248 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3249 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3250 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3251 | the_insn.pcrel = 1;
|
---|
3252 | if (!the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol
|
---|
3253 | || !strcmp (S_GET_NAME (the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol),
|
---|
3254 | FAKE_LABEL_NAME))
|
---|
3255 | {
|
---|
3256 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3257 | if (num % 4)
|
---|
3258 | {
|
---|
3259 | as_bad (_("Branch to unaligned address"));
|
---|
3260 | break;
|
---|
3261 | }
|
---|
3262 | if (the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol)
|
---|
3263 | num -= 8;
|
---|
3264 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 8191, -8192, 0);
|
---|
3265 | opcode |= re_assemble_12 (num >> 2);
|
---|
3266 | continue;
|
---|
3267 | }
|
---|
3268 | else
|
---|
3269 | {
|
---|
3270 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3271 | the_insn.format = 12;
|
---|
3272 | the_insn.arg_reloc = last_call_desc.arg_reloc;
|
---|
3273 | memset (&last_call_desc, 0, sizeof (struct call_desc));
|
---|
3274 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3275 | continue;
|
---|
3276 | }
|
---|
3277 |
|
---|
3278 | /* Handle a 17 bit branch displacement. */
|
---|
3279 | case 'W':
|
---|
3280 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3281 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3282 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3283 | the_insn.pcrel = 1;
|
---|
3284 | if (!the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol
|
---|
3285 | || !strcmp (S_GET_NAME (the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol),
|
---|
3286 | FAKE_LABEL_NAME))
|
---|
3287 | {
|
---|
3288 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3289 | if (num % 4)
|
---|
3290 | {
|
---|
3291 | as_bad (_("Branch to unaligned address"));
|
---|
3292 | break;
|
---|
3293 | }
|
---|
3294 | if (the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol)
|
---|
3295 | num -= 8;
|
---|
3296 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 262143, -262144, 0);
|
---|
3297 | opcode |= re_assemble_17 (num >> 2);
|
---|
3298 | continue;
|
---|
3299 | }
|
---|
3300 | else
|
---|
3301 | {
|
---|
3302 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3303 | the_insn.format = 17;
|
---|
3304 | the_insn.arg_reloc = last_call_desc.arg_reloc;
|
---|
3305 | memset (&last_call_desc, 0, sizeof (struct call_desc));
|
---|
3306 | continue;
|
---|
3307 | }
|
---|
3308 |
|
---|
3309 | /* Handle a 22 bit branch displacement. */
|
---|
3310 | case 'X':
|
---|
3311 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3312 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3313 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3314 | the_insn.pcrel = 1;
|
---|
3315 | if (!the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol
|
---|
3316 | || !strcmp (S_GET_NAME (the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol),
|
---|
3317 | FAKE_LABEL_NAME))
|
---|
3318 | {
|
---|
3319 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3320 | if (num % 4)
|
---|
3321 | {
|
---|
3322 | as_bad (_("Branch to unaligned address"));
|
---|
3323 | break;
|
---|
3324 | }
|
---|
3325 | if (the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol)
|
---|
3326 | num -= 8;
|
---|
3327 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 8388607, -8388608, 0);
|
---|
3328 | opcode |= re_assemble_22 (num >> 2);
|
---|
3329 | }
|
---|
3330 | else
|
---|
3331 | {
|
---|
3332 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL;
|
---|
3333 | the_insn.format = 22;
|
---|
3334 | the_insn.arg_reloc = last_call_desc.arg_reloc;
|
---|
3335 | memset (&last_call_desc, 0, sizeof (struct call_desc));
|
---|
3336 | continue;
|
---|
3337 | }
|
---|
3338 |
|
---|
3339 | /* Handle an absolute 17 bit branch target. */
|
---|
3340 | case 'z':
|
---|
3341 | the_insn.field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (&s);
|
---|
3342 | get_expression (s);
|
---|
3343 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3344 | the_insn.pcrel = 0;
|
---|
3345 | if (!the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol
|
---|
3346 | || !strcmp (S_GET_NAME (the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol),
|
---|
3347 | FAKE_LABEL_NAME))
|
---|
3348 | {
|
---|
3349 | num = evaluate_absolute (&the_insn);
|
---|
3350 | if (num % 4)
|
---|
3351 | {
|
---|
3352 | as_bad (_("Branch to unaligned address"));
|
---|
3353 | break;
|
---|
3354 | }
|
---|
3355 | if (the_insn.exp.X_add_symbol)
|
---|
3356 | num -= 8;
|
---|
3357 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 262143, -262144, 0);
|
---|
3358 | opcode |= re_assemble_17 (num >> 2);
|
---|
3359 | continue;
|
---|
3360 | }
|
---|
3361 | else
|
---|
3362 | {
|
---|
3363 | the_insn.reloc = R_HPPA_ABS_CALL;
|
---|
3364 | the_insn.format = 17;
|
---|
3365 | the_insn.arg_reloc = last_call_desc.arg_reloc;
|
---|
3366 | memset (&last_call_desc, 0, sizeof (struct call_desc));
|
---|
3367 | continue;
|
---|
3368 | }
|
---|
3369 |
|
---|
3370 | /* Handle '%r1' implicit operand of addil instruction. */
|
---|
3371 | case 'Z':
|
---|
3372 | if (*s == ',' && *(s + 1) == '%' && *(s + 3) == '1'
|
---|
3373 | && (*(s + 2) == 'r' || *(s + 2) == 'R'))
|
---|
3374 | {
|
---|
3375 | s += 4;
|
---|
3376 | continue;
|
---|
3377 | }
|
---|
3378 | else
|
---|
3379 | break;
|
---|
3380 |
|
---|
3381 | /* Handle '%sr0,%r31' implicit operand of be,l instruction. */
|
---|
3382 | case 'Y':
|
---|
3383 | if (strncasecmp (s, "%sr0,%r31", 9) != 0)
|
---|
3384 | break;
|
---|
3385 | s += 9;
|
---|
3386 | continue;
|
---|
3387 |
|
---|
3388 | /* Handle immediate value of 0 for ordered load/store instructions. */
|
---|
3389 | case '@':
|
---|
3390 | if (*s != '0')
|
---|
3391 | break;
|
---|
3392 | s++;
|
---|
3393 | continue;
|
---|
3394 |
|
---|
3395 | /* Handle a 2 bit shift count at 25. */
|
---|
3396 | case '.':
|
---|
3397 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3398 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3399 | break;
|
---|
3400 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3401 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 3, 1, strict);
|
---|
3402 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 6);
|
---|
3403 |
|
---|
3404 | /* Handle a 4 bit shift count at 25. */
|
---|
3405 | case '*':
|
---|
3406 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3407 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3408 | break;
|
---|
3409 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3410 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 15, 0, strict);
|
---|
3411 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 6);
|
---|
3412 |
|
---|
3413 | /* Handle a 5 bit shift count at 26. */
|
---|
3414 | case 'p':
|
---|
3415 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3416 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3417 | break;
|
---|
3418 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3419 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, strict);
|
---|
3420 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, 31 - num, 5);
|
---|
3421 |
|
---|
3422 | /* Handle a 6 bit shift count at 20,22:26. */
|
---|
3423 | case '~':
|
---|
3424 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3425 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3426 | break;
|
---|
3427 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3428 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 63, 0, strict);
|
---|
3429 | num = 63 - num;
|
---|
3430 | opcode |= (num & 0x20) << 6;
|
---|
3431 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num & 0x1f, 5);
|
---|
3432 |
|
---|
3433 | /* Handle a 6 bit field length at 23,27:31. */
|
---|
3434 | case '%':
|
---|
3435 | flag = 0;
|
---|
3436 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3437 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3438 | break;
|
---|
3439 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3440 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 64, 1, strict);
|
---|
3441 | num--;
|
---|
3442 | opcode |= (num & 0x20) << 3;
|
---|
3443 | num = 31 - (num & 0x1f);
|
---|
3444 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3445 |
|
---|
3446 | /* Handle a 6 bit field length at 19,27:31. */
|
---|
3447 | case '|':
|
---|
3448 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3449 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3450 | break;
|
---|
3451 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3452 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 64, 1, strict);
|
---|
3453 | num--;
|
---|
3454 | opcode |= (num & 0x20) << 7;
|
---|
3455 | num = 31 - (num & 0x1f);
|
---|
3456 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3457 |
|
---|
3458 | /* Handle a 5 bit bit position at 26. */
|
---|
3459 | case 'P':
|
---|
3460 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3461 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3462 | break;
|
---|
3463 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3464 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, strict);
|
---|
3465 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 5);
|
---|
3466 |
|
---|
3467 | /* Handle a 6 bit bit position at 20,22:26. */
|
---|
3468 | case 'q':
|
---|
3469 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3470 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3471 | break;
|
---|
3472 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3473 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 63, 0, strict);
|
---|
3474 | opcode |= (num & 0x20) << 6;
|
---|
3475 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num & 0x1f, 5);
|
---|
3476 |
|
---|
3477 | /* Handle a 5 bit immediate at 10 with 'd' as the complement
|
---|
3478 | of the high bit of the immediate. */
|
---|
3479 | case 'B':
|
---|
3480 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3481 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3482 | break;
|
---|
3483 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3484 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 63, 0, strict);
|
---|
3485 | if (num & 0x20)
|
---|
3486 | ;
|
---|
3487 | else
|
---|
3488 | opcode |= (1 << 13);
|
---|
3489 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num & 0x1f, 21);
|
---|
3490 |
|
---|
3491 | /* Handle a 5 bit immediate at 10. */
|
---|
3492 | case 'Q':
|
---|
3493 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3494 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3495 | break;
|
---|
3496 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3497 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, strict);
|
---|
3498 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 21);
|
---|
3499 |
|
---|
3500 | /* Handle a 9 bit immediate at 28. */
|
---|
3501 | case '$':
|
---|
3502 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3503 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3504 | break;
|
---|
3505 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3506 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 511, 1, strict);
|
---|
3507 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 3);
|
---|
3508 |
|
---|
3509 | /* Handle a 13 bit immediate at 18. */
|
---|
3510 | case 'A':
|
---|
3511 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3512 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3513 | break;
|
---|
3514 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3515 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 8191, 0, strict);
|
---|
3516 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 13);
|
---|
3517 |
|
---|
3518 | /* Handle a 26 bit immediate at 31. */
|
---|
3519 | case 'D':
|
---|
3520 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3521 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3522 | break;
|
---|
3523 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3524 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 67108863, 0, strict);
|
---|
3525 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3526 |
|
---|
3527 | /* Handle a 3 bit SFU identifier at 25. */
|
---|
3528 | case 'v':
|
---|
3529 | if (*s++ != ',')
|
---|
3530 | as_bad (_("Invalid SFU identifier"));
|
---|
3531 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3532 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3533 | break;
|
---|
3534 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3535 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 7, 0, strict);
|
---|
3536 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 6);
|
---|
3537 |
|
---|
3538 | /* Handle a 20 bit SOP field for spop0. */
|
---|
3539 | case 'O':
|
---|
3540 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3541 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3542 | break;
|
---|
3543 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3544 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 1048575, 0, strict);
|
---|
3545 | num = (num & 0x1f) | ((num & 0x000fffe0) << 6);
|
---|
3546 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3547 |
|
---|
3548 | /* Handle a 15bit SOP field for spop1. */
|
---|
3549 | case 'o':
|
---|
3550 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3551 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3552 | break;
|
---|
3553 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3554 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 32767, 0, strict);
|
---|
3555 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 11);
|
---|
3556 |
|
---|
3557 | /* Handle a 10bit SOP field for spop3. */
|
---|
3558 | case '0':
|
---|
3559 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3560 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3561 | break;
|
---|
3562 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3563 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 1023, 0, strict);
|
---|
3564 | num = (num & 0x1f) | ((num & 0x000003e0) << 6);
|
---|
3565 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3566 |
|
---|
3567 | /* Handle a 15 bit SOP field for spop2. */
|
---|
3568 | case '1':
|
---|
3569 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3570 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3571 | break;
|
---|
3572 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3573 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 32767, 0, strict);
|
---|
3574 | num = (num & 0x1f) | ((num & 0x00007fe0) << 6);
|
---|
3575 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3576 |
|
---|
3577 | /* Handle a 3-bit co-processor ID field. */
|
---|
3578 | case 'u':
|
---|
3579 | if (*s++ != ',')
|
---|
3580 | as_bad (_("Invalid COPR identifier"));
|
---|
3581 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3582 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3583 | break;
|
---|
3584 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3585 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 7, 0, strict);
|
---|
3586 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 6);
|
---|
3587 |
|
---|
3588 | /* Handle a 22bit SOP field for copr. */
|
---|
3589 | case '2':
|
---|
3590 | num = pa_get_absolute_expression (&the_insn, &s);
|
---|
3591 | if (strict && the_insn.exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
3592 | break;
|
---|
3593 | s = expr_end;
|
---|
3594 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 4194303, 0, strict);
|
---|
3595 | num = (num & 0x1f) | ((num & 0x003fffe0) << 4);
|
---|
3596 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3597 |
|
---|
3598 | /* Handle a source FP operand format completer. */
|
---|
3599 | case '{':
|
---|
3600 | if (*s == ',' && *(s+1) == 't')
|
---|
3601 | {
|
---|
3602 | the_insn.trunc = 1;
|
---|
3603 | s += 2;
|
---|
3604 | }
|
---|
3605 | else
|
---|
3606 | the_insn.trunc = 0;
|
---|
3607 | flag = pa_parse_fp_cnv_format (&s);
|
---|
3608 | the_insn.fpof1 = flag;
|
---|
3609 | if (flag == W || flag == UW)
|
---|
3610 | flag = SGL;
|
---|
3611 | if (flag == DW || flag == UDW)
|
---|
3612 | flag = DBL;
|
---|
3613 | if (flag == QW || flag == UQW)
|
---|
3614 | flag = QUAD;
|
---|
3615 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
3616 |
|
---|
3617 | /* Handle a destination FP operand format completer. */
|
---|
3618 | case '_':
|
---|
3619 | /* pa_parse_format needs the ',' prefix. */
|
---|
3620 | s--;
|
---|
3621 | flag = pa_parse_fp_cnv_format (&s);
|
---|
3622 | the_insn.fpof2 = flag;
|
---|
3623 | if (flag == W || flag == UW)
|
---|
3624 | flag = SGL;
|
---|
3625 | if (flag == DW || flag == UDW)
|
---|
3626 | flag = DBL;
|
---|
3627 | if (flag == QW || flag == UQW)
|
---|
3628 | flag = QUAD;
|
---|
3629 | opcode |= flag << 13;
|
---|
3630 | if (the_insn.fpof1 == SGL
|
---|
3631 | || the_insn.fpof1 == DBL
|
---|
3632 | || the_insn.fpof1 == QUAD)
|
---|
3633 | {
|
---|
3634 | if (the_insn.fpof2 == SGL
|
---|
3635 | || the_insn.fpof2 == DBL
|
---|
3636 | || the_insn.fpof2 == QUAD)
|
---|
3637 | flag = 0;
|
---|
3638 | else if (the_insn.fpof2 == W
|
---|
3639 | || the_insn.fpof2 == DW
|
---|
3640 | || the_insn.fpof2 == QW)
|
---|
3641 | flag = 2;
|
---|
3642 | else if (the_insn.fpof2 == UW
|
---|
3643 | || the_insn.fpof2 == UDW
|
---|
3644 | || the_insn.fpof2 == UQW)
|
---|
3645 | flag = 6;
|
---|
3646 | else
|
---|
3647 | abort ();
|
---|
3648 | }
|
---|
3649 | else if (the_insn.fpof1 == W
|
---|
3650 | || the_insn.fpof1 == DW
|
---|
3651 | || the_insn.fpof1 == QW)
|
---|
3652 | {
|
---|
3653 | if (the_insn.fpof2 == SGL
|
---|
3654 | || the_insn.fpof2 == DBL
|
---|
3655 | || the_insn.fpof2 == QUAD)
|
---|
3656 | flag = 1;
|
---|
3657 | else
|
---|
3658 | abort ();
|
---|
3659 | }
|
---|
3660 | else if (the_insn.fpof1 == UW
|
---|
3661 | || the_insn.fpof1 == UDW
|
---|
3662 | || the_insn.fpof1 == UQW)
|
---|
3663 | {
|
---|
3664 | if (the_insn.fpof2 == SGL
|
---|
3665 | || the_insn.fpof2 == DBL
|
---|
3666 | || the_insn.fpof2 == QUAD)
|
---|
3667 | flag = 5;
|
---|
3668 | else
|
---|
3669 | abort ();
|
---|
3670 | }
|
---|
3671 | flag |= the_insn.trunc;
|
---|
3672 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 15);
|
---|
3673 |
|
---|
3674 | /* Handle a source FP operand format completer. */
|
---|
3675 | case 'F':
|
---|
3676 | flag = pa_parse_fp_format (&s);
|
---|
3677 | the_insn.fpof1 = flag;
|
---|
3678 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
3679 |
|
---|
3680 | /* Handle a destination FP operand format completer. */
|
---|
3681 | case 'G':
|
---|
3682 | /* pa_parse_format needs the ',' prefix. */
|
---|
3683 | s--;
|
---|
3684 | flag = pa_parse_fp_format (&s);
|
---|
3685 | the_insn.fpof2 = flag;
|
---|
3686 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 13);
|
---|
3687 |
|
---|
3688 | /* Handle a source FP operand format completer at 20. */
|
---|
3689 | case 'I':
|
---|
3690 | flag = pa_parse_fp_format (&s);
|
---|
3691 | the_insn.fpof1 = flag;
|
---|
3692 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, flag, 11);
|
---|
3693 |
|
---|
3694 | /* Handle a floating point operand format at 26.
|
---|
3695 | Only allows single and double precision. */
|
---|
3696 | case 'H':
|
---|
3697 | flag = pa_parse_fp_format (&s);
|
---|
3698 | switch (flag)
|
---|
3699 | {
|
---|
3700 | case SGL:
|
---|
3701 | opcode |= 0x20;
|
---|
3702 | case DBL:
|
---|
3703 | the_insn.fpof1 = flag;
|
---|
3704 | continue;
|
---|
3705 |
|
---|
3706 | case QUAD:
|
---|
3707 | case ILLEGAL_FMT:
|
---|
3708 | default:
|
---|
3709 | as_bad (_("Invalid Floating Point Operand Format."));
|
---|
3710 | }
|
---|
3711 | break;
|
---|
3712 |
|
---|
3713 | /* Handle all floating point registers. */
|
---|
3714 | case 'f':
|
---|
3715 | switch (*++args)
|
---|
3716 | {
|
---|
3717 | /* Float target register. */
|
---|
3718 | case 't':
|
---|
3719 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 3))
|
---|
3720 | break;
|
---|
3721 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3722 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3723 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3724 |
|
---|
3725 | /* Float target register with L/R selection. */
|
---|
3726 | case 'T':
|
---|
3727 | {
|
---|
3728 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3729 | break;
|
---|
3730 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3731 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3732 | opcode |= num;
|
---|
3733 |
|
---|
3734 | /* 0x30 opcodes are FP arithmetic operation opcodes
|
---|
3735 | and need to be turned into 0x38 opcodes. This
|
---|
3736 | is not necessary for loads/stores. */
|
---|
3737 | if (need_pa11_opcode ()
|
---|
3738 | && ((opcode & 0xfc000000) == 0x30000000))
|
---|
3739 | opcode |= 1 << 27;
|
---|
3740 |
|
---|
3741 | opcode |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 6 : 0);
|
---|
3742 | continue;
|
---|
3743 | }
|
---|
3744 |
|
---|
3745 | /* Float operand 1. */
|
---|
3746 | case 'a':
|
---|
3747 | {
|
---|
3748 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3749 | break;
|
---|
3750 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3751 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3752 | opcode |= num << 21;
|
---|
3753 | if (need_pa11_opcode ())
|
---|
3754 | {
|
---|
3755 | opcode |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 7 : 0);
|
---|
3756 | opcode |= 1 << 27;
|
---|
3757 | }
|
---|
3758 | continue;
|
---|
3759 | }
|
---|
3760 |
|
---|
3761 | /* Float operand 1 with L/R selection. */
|
---|
3762 | case 'X':
|
---|
3763 | case 'A':
|
---|
3764 | {
|
---|
3765 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3766 | break;
|
---|
3767 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3768 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3769 | opcode |= num << 21;
|
---|
3770 | opcode |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 7 : 0);
|
---|
3771 | continue;
|
---|
3772 | }
|
---|
3773 |
|
---|
3774 | /* Float operand 2. */
|
---|
3775 | case 'b':
|
---|
3776 | {
|
---|
3777 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3778 | break;
|
---|
3779 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3780 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3781 | opcode |= num << 16;
|
---|
3782 | if (need_pa11_opcode ())
|
---|
3783 | {
|
---|
3784 | opcode |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 12 : 0);
|
---|
3785 | opcode |= 1 << 27;
|
---|
3786 | }
|
---|
3787 | continue;
|
---|
3788 | }
|
---|
3789 |
|
---|
3790 | /* Float operand 2 with L/R selection. */
|
---|
3791 | case 'B':
|
---|
3792 | {
|
---|
3793 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3794 | break;
|
---|
3795 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3796 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3797 | opcode |= num << 16;
|
---|
3798 | opcode |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 12 : 0);
|
---|
3799 | continue;
|
---|
3800 | }
|
---|
3801 |
|
---|
3802 | /* Float operand 3 for fmpyfadd, fmpynfadd. */
|
---|
3803 | case 'C':
|
---|
3804 | {
|
---|
3805 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3806 | break;
|
---|
3807 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3808 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3809 | opcode |= (num & 0x1c) << 11;
|
---|
3810 | opcode |= (num & 0x03) << 9;
|
---|
3811 | opcode |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 8 : 0);
|
---|
3812 | continue;
|
---|
3813 | }
|
---|
3814 |
|
---|
3815 | /* Float mult operand 1 for fmpyadd, fmpysub */
|
---|
3816 | case 'i':
|
---|
3817 | {
|
---|
3818 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3819 | break;
|
---|
3820 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3821 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3822 | if (the_insn.fpof1 == SGL)
|
---|
3823 | {
|
---|
3824 | if (num < 16)
|
---|
3825 | {
|
---|
3826 | as_bad (_("Invalid register for single precision fmpyadd or fmpysub"));
|
---|
3827 | break;
|
---|
3828 | }
|
---|
3829 | num &= 0xF;
|
---|
3830 | num |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 4 : 0);
|
---|
3831 | }
|
---|
3832 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 21);
|
---|
3833 | }
|
---|
3834 |
|
---|
3835 | /* Float mult operand 2 for fmpyadd, fmpysub */
|
---|
3836 | case 'j':
|
---|
3837 | {
|
---|
3838 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3839 | break;
|
---|
3840 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3841 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3842 | if (the_insn.fpof1 == SGL)
|
---|
3843 | {
|
---|
3844 | if (num < 16)
|
---|
3845 | {
|
---|
3846 | as_bad (_("Invalid register for single precision fmpyadd or fmpysub"));
|
---|
3847 | break;
|
---|
3848 | }
|
---|
3849 | num &= 0xF;
|
---|
3850 | num |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 4 : 0);
|
---|
3851 | }
|
---|
3852 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 16);
|
---|
3853 | }
|
---|
3854 |
|
---|
3855 | /* Float mult target for fmpyadd, fmpysub */
|
---|
3856 | case 'k':
|
---|
3857 | {
|
---|
3858 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3859 | break;
|
---|
3860 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3861 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3862 | if (the_insn.fpof1 == SGL)
|
---|
3863 | {
|
---|
3864 | if (num < 16)
|
---|
3865 | {
|
---|
3866 | as_bad (_("Invalid register for single precision fmpyadd or fmpysub"));
|
---|
3867 | break;
|
---|
3868 | }
|
---|
3869 | num &= 0xF;
|
---|
3870 | num |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 4 : 0);
|
---|
3871 | }
|
---|
3872 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 0);
|
---|
3873 | }
|
---|
3874 |
|
---|
3875 | /* Float add operand 1 for fmpyadd, fmpysub */
|
---|
3876 | case 'l':
|
---|
3877 | {
|
---|
3878 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3879 | break;
|
---|
3880 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3881 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3882 | if (the_insn.fpof1 == SGL)
|
---|
3883 | {
|
---|
3884 | if (num < 16)
|
---|
3885 | {
|
---|
3886 | as_bad (_("Invalid register for single precision fmpyadd or fmpysub"));
|
---|
3887 | break;
|
---|
3888 | }
|
---|
3889 | num &= 0xF;
|
---|
3890 | num |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 4 : 0);
|
---|
3891 | }
|
---|
3892 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 6);
|
---|
3893 | }
|
---|
3894 |
|
---|
3895 | /* Float add target for fmpyadd, fmpysub */
|
---|
3896 | case 'm':
|
---|
3897 | {
|
---|
3898 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3899 | break;
|
---|
3900 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3901 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3902 | if (the_insn.fpof1 == SGL)
|
---|
3903 | {
|
---|
3904 | if (num < 16)
|
---|
3905 | {
|
---|
3906 | as_bad (_("Invalid register for single precision fmpyadd or fmpysub"));
|
---|
3907 | break;
|
---|
3908 | }
|
---|
3909 | num &= 0xF;
|
---|
3910 | num |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 4 : 0);
|
---|
3911 | }
|
---|
3912 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 11);
|
---|
3913 | }
|
---|
3914 |
|
---|
3915 | /* Handle L/R register halves like 'x'. */
|
---|
3916 | case 'E':
|
---|
3917 | case 'e':
|
---|
3918 | {
|
---|
3919 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 1))
|
---|
3920 | break;
|
---|
3921 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3922 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3923 | opcode |= num << 16;
|
---|
3924 | if (need_pa11_opcode ())
|
---|
3925 | {
|
---|
3926 | opcode |= (pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL ? 1 << 1 : 0);
|
---|
3927 | }
|
---|
3928 | continue;
|
---|
3929 | }
|
---|
3930 |
|
---|
3931 | /* Float target register (PA 2.0 wide). */
|
---|
3932 | case 'x':
|
---|
3933 | if (!pa_parse_number (&s, 3))
|
---|
3934 | break;
|
---|
3935 | num = (pa_number & ~FP_REG_RSEL) - FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
3936 | CHECK_FIELD (num, 31, 0, 0);
|
---|
3937 | INSERT_FIELD_AND_CONTINUE (opcode, num, 16);
|
---|
3938 |
|
---|
3939 | default:
|
---|
3940 | abort ();
|
---|
3941 | }
|
---|
3942 | break;
|
---|
3943 |
|
---|
3944 | default:
|
---|
3945 | abort ();
|
---|
3946 | }
|
---|
3947 | break;
|
---|
3948 | }
|
---|
3949 |
|
---|
3950 | failed:
|
---|
3951 | /* Check if the args matched. */
|
---|
3952 | if (!match)
|
---|
3953 | {
|
---|
3954 | if (&insn[1] - pa_opcodes < (int) NUMOPCODES
|
---|
3955 | && !strcmp (insn->name, insn[1].name))
|
---|
3956 | {
|
---|
3957 | ++insn;
|
---|
3958 | s = argstart;
|
---|
3959 | continue;
|
---|
3960 | }
|
---|
3961 | else
|
---|
3962 | {
|
---|
3963 | as_bad (_("Invalid operands %s"), error_message);
|
---|
3964 | return;
|
---|
3965 | }
|
---|
3966 | }
|
---|
3967 | break;
|
---|
3968 | }
|
---|
3969 |
|
---|
3970 | the_insn.opcode = opcode;
|
---|
3971 | }
|
---|
3972 |
|
---|
3973 | /* Turn a string in input_line_pointer into a floating point constant of type
|
---|
3974 | type, and store the appropriate bytes in *litP. The number of LITTLENUMS
|
---|
3975 | emitted is stored in *sizeP . An error message or NULL is returned. */
|
---|
3976 |
|
---|
3977 | #define MAX_LITTLENUMS 6
|
---|
3978 |
|
---|
3979 | char *
|
---|
3980 | md_atof (type, litP, sizeP)
|
---|
3981 | char type;
|
---|
3982 | char *litP;
|
---|
3983 | int *sizeP;
|
---|
3984 | {
|
---|
3985 | int prec;
|
---|
3986 | LITTLENUM_TYPE words[MAX_LITTLENUMS];
|
---|
3987 | LITTLENUM_TYPE *wordP;
|
---|
3988 | char *t;
|
---|
3989 |
|
---|
3990 | switch (type)
|
---|
3991 | {
|
---|
3992 |
|
---|
3993 | case 'f':
|
---|
3994 | case 'F':
|
---|
3995 | case 's':
|
---|
3996 | case 'S':
|
---|
3997 | prec = 2;
|
---|
3998 | break;
|
---|
3999 |
|
---|
4000 | case 'd':
|
---|
4001 | case 'D':
|
---|
4002 | case 'r':
|
---|
4003 | case 'R':
|
---|
4004 | prec = 4;
|
---|
4005 | break;
|
---|
4006 |
|
---|
4007 | case 'x':
|
---|
4008 | case 'X':
|
---|
4009 | prec = 6;
|
---|
4010 | break;
|
---|
4011 |
|
---|
4012 | case 'p':
|
---|
4013 | case 'P':
|
---|
4014 | prec = 6;
|
---|
4015 | break;
|
---|
4016 |
|
---|
4017 | default:
|
---|
4018 | *sizeP = 0;
|
---|
4019 | return _("Bad call to MD_ATOF()");
|
---|
4020 | }
|
---|
4021 | t = atof_ieee (input_line_pointer, type, words);
|
---|
4022 | if (t)
|
---|
4023 | input_line_pointer = t;
|
---|
4024 | *sizeP = prec * sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
|
---|
4025 | for (wordP = words; prec--;)
|
---|
4026 | {
|
---|
4027 | md_number_to_chars (litP, (valueT) (*wordP++), sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE));
|
---|
4028 | litP += sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
|
---|
4029 | }
|
---|
4030 | return NULL;
|
---|
4031 | }
|
---|
4032 |
|
---|
4033 | /* Write out big-endian. */
|
---|
4034 |
|
---|
4035 | void
|
---|
4036 | md_number_to_chars (buf, val, n)
|
---|
4037 | char *buf;
|
---|
4038 | valueT val;
|
---|
4039 | int n;
|
---|
4040 | {
|
---|
4041 | number_to_chars_bigendian (buf, val, n);
|
---|
4042 | }
|
---|
4043 |
|
---|
4044 | /* Translate internal representation of relocation info to BFD target
|
---|
4045 | format. */
|
---|
4046 |
|
---|
4047 | arelent **
|
---|
4048 | tc_gen_reloc (section, fixp)
|
---|
4049 | asection *section;
|
---|
4050 | fixS *fixp;
|
---|
4051 | {
|
---|
4052 | arelent *reloc;
|
---|
4053 | struct hppa_fix_struct *hppa_fixp;
|
---|
4054 | static arelent *no_relocs = NULL;
|
---|
4055 | arelent **relocs;
|
---|
4056 | reloc_type **codes;
|
---|
4057 | reloc_type code;
|
---|
4058 | int n_relocs;
|
---|
4059 | int i;
|
---|
4060 |
|
---|
4061 | hppa_fixp = (struct hppa_fix_struct *) fixp->tc_fix_data;
|
---|
4062 | if (fixp->fx_addsy == 0)
|
---|
4063 | return &no_relocs;
|
---|
4064 |
|
---|
4065 | assert (hppa_fixp != 0);
|
---|
4066 | assert (section != 0);
|
---|
4067 |
|
---|
4068 | reloc = (arelent *) xmalloc (sizeof (arelent));
|
---|
4069 |
|
---|
4070 | reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
|
---|
4071 | *reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_addsy);
|
---|
4072 | codes = hppa_gen_reloc_type (stdoutput,
|
---|
4073 | fixp->fx_r_type,
|
---|
4074 | hppa_fixp->fx_r_format,
|
---|
4075 | hppa_fixp->fx_r_field,
|
---|
4076 | fixp->fx_subsy != NULL,
|
---|
4077 | symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_addsy));
|
---|
4078 |
|
---|
4079 | if (codes == NULL)
|
---|
4080 | {
|
---|
4081 | as_bad_where (fixp->fx_file, fixp->fx_line, _("Cannot handle fixup"));
|
---|
4082 | abort ();
|
---|
4083 | }
|
---|
4084 |
|
---|
4085 | for (n_relocs = 0; codes[n_relocs]; n_relocs++)
|
---|
4086 | ;
|
---|
4087 |
|
---|
4088 | relocs = (arelent **) xmalloc (sizeof (arelent *) * n_relocs + 1);
|
---|
4089 | reloc = (arelent *) xmalloc (sizeof (arelent) * n_relocs);
|
---|
4090 | for (i = 0; i < n_relocs; i++)
|
---|
4091 | relocs[i] = &reloc[i];
|
---|
4092 |
|
---|
4093 | relocs[n_relocs] = NULL;
|
---|
4094 |
|
---|
4095 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
4096 | switch (fixp->fx_r_type)
|
---|
4097 | {
|
---|
4098 | default:
|
---|
4099 | assert (n_relocs == 1);
|
---|
4100 |
|
---|
4101 | code = *codes[0];
|
---|
4102 |
|
---|
4103 | /* Now, do any processing that is dependent on the relocation type. */
|
---|
4104 | switch (code)
|
---|
4105 | {
|
---|
4106 | case R_PARISC_DLTREL21L:
|
---|
4107 | case R_PARISC_DLTREL14R:
|
---|
4108 | case R_PARISC_DLTREL14F:
|
---|
4109 | case R_PARISC_PLABEL32:
|
---|
4110 | case R_PARISC_PLABEL21L:
|
---|
4111 | case R_PARISC_PLABEL14R:
|
---|
4112 | /* For plabel relocations, the addend of the
|
---|
4113 | relocation should be either 0 (no static link) or 2
|
---|
4114 | (static link required). This adjustment is done in
|
---|
4115 | bfd/elf32-hppa.c:elf32_hppa_relocate_section.
|
---|
4116 |
|
---|
4117 | We also slam a zero addend into the DLT relative relocs;
|
---|
4118 | it doesn't make a lot of sense to use any addend since
|
---|
4119 | it gets you a different (eg unknown) DLT entry. */
|
---|
4120 | reloc->addend = 0;
|
---|
4121 | break;
|
---|
4122 |
|
---|
4123 | #ifdef ELF_ARG_RELOC
|
---|
4124 | case R_PARISC_PCREL17R:
|
---|
4125 | case R_PARISC_PCREL17F:
|
---|
4126 | case R_PARISC_PCREL17C:
|
---|
4127 | case R_PARISC_DIR17R:
|
---|
4128 | case R_PARISC_DIR17F:
|
---|
4129 | case R_PARISC_PCREL21L:
|
---|
4130 | case R_PARISC_DIR21L:
|
---|
4131 | reloc->addend = HPPA_R_ADDEND (hppa_fixp->fx_arg_reloc,
|
---|
4132 | fixp->fx_offset);
|
---|
4133 | break;
|
---|
4134 | #endif
|
---|
4135 |
|
---|
4136 | case R_PARISC_DIR32:
|
---|
4137 | /* Facilitate hand-crafted unwind info. */
|
---|
4138 | if (strcmp (section->name, UNWIND_SECTION_NAME) == 0)
|
---|
4139 | code = R_PARISC_SEGREL32;
|
---|
4140 | /* Fall thru */
|
---|
4141 |
|
---|
4142 | default:
|
---|
4143 | reloc->addend = fixp->fx_offset;
|
---|
4144 | break;
|
---|
4145 | }
|
---|
4146 |
|
---|
4147 | reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
|
---|
4148 | *reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_addsy);
|
---|
4149 | reloc->howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput,
|
---|
4150 | (bfd_reloc_code_real_type) code);
|
---|
4151 | reloc->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
|
---|
4152 |
|
---|
4153 | assert (reloc->howto && (unsigned int) code == reloc->howto->type);
|
---|
4154 | break;
|
---|
4155 | }
|
---|
4156 | #else /* OBJ_SOM */
|
---|
4157 |
|
---|
4158 | /* Walk over reach relocation returned by the BFD backend. */
|
---|
4159 | for (i = 0; i < n_relocs; i++)
|
---|
4160 | {
|
---|
4161 | code = *codes[i];
|
---|
4162 |
|
---|
4163 | relocs[i]->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
|
---|
4164 | *relocs[i]->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_addsy);
|
---|
4165 | relocs[i]->howto =
|
---|
4166 | bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput,
|
---|
4167 | (bfd_reloc_code_real_type) code);
|
---|
4168 | relocs[i]->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
|
---|
4169 |
|
---|
4170 | switch (code)
|
---|
4171 | {
|
---|
4172 | case R_COMP2:
|
---|
4173 | /* The only time we ever use a R_COMP2 fixup is for the difference
|
---|
4174 | of two symbols. With that in mind we fill in all four
|
---|
4175 | relocs now and break out of the loop. */
|
---|
4176 | assert (i == 1);
|
---|
4177 | relocs[0]->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) &(bfd_abs_symbol);
|
---|
4178 | relocs[0]->howto =
|
---|
4179 | bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput,
|
---|
4180 | (bfd_reloc_code_real_type) *codes[0]);
|
---|
4181 | relocs[0]->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
|
---|
4182 | relocs[0]->addend = 0;
|
---|
4183 | relocs[1]->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
|
---|
4184 | *relocs[1]->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_addsy);
|
---|
4185 | relocs[1]->howto =
|
---|
4186 | bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput,
|
---|
4187 | (bfd_reloc_code_real_type) *codes[1]);
|
---|
4188 | relocs[1]->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
|
---|
4189 | relocs[1]->addend = 0;
|
---|
4190 | relocs[2]->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
|
---|
4191 | *relocs[2]->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_subsy);
|
---|
4192 | relocs[2]->howto =
|
---|
4193 | bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput,
|
---|
4194 | (bfd_reloc_code_real_type) *codes[2]);
|
---|
4195 | relocs[2]->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
|
---|
4196 | relocs[2]->addend = 0;
|
---|
4197 | relocs[3]->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) &(bfd_abs_symbol);
|
---|
4198 | relocs[3]->howto =
|
---|
4199 | bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput,
|
---|
4200 | (bfd_reloc_code_real_type) *codes[3]);
|
---|
4201 | relocs[3]->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
|
---|
4202 | relocs[3]->addend = 0;
|
---|
4203 | relocs[4]->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) &(bfd_abs_symbol);
|
---|
4204 | relocs[4]->howto =
|
---|
4205 | bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput,
|
---|
4206 | (bfd_reloc_code_real_type) *codes[4]);
|
---|
4207 | relocs[4]->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
|
---|
4208 | relocs[4]->addend = 0;
|
---|
4209 | goto done;
|
---|
4210 | case R_PCREL_CALL:
|
---|
4211 | case R_ABS_CALL:
|
---|
4212 | relocs[i]->addend = HPPA_R_ADDEND (hppa_fixp->fx_arg_reloc, 0);
|
---|
4213 | break;
|
---|
4214 |
|
---|
4215 | case R_DLT_REL:
|
---|
4216 | case R_DATA_PLABEL:
|
---|
4217 | case R_CODE_PLABEL:
|
---|
4218 | /* For plabel relocations, the addend of the
|
---|
4219 | relocation should be either 0 (no static link) or 2
|
---|
4220 | (static link required).
|
---|
4221 |
|
---|
4222 | FIXME: We always assume no static link!
|
---|
4223 |
|
---|
4224 | We also slam a zero addend into the DLT relative relocs;
|
---|
4225 | it doesn't make a lot of sense to use any addend since
|
---|
4226 | it gets you a different (eg unknown) DLT entry. */
|
---|
4227 | relocs[i]->addend = 0;
|
---|
4228 | break;
|
---|
4229 |
|
---|
4230 | case R_N_MODE:
|
---|
4231 | case R_S_MODE:
|
---|
4232 | case R_D_MODE:
|
---|
4233 | case R_R_MODE:
|
---|
4234 | case R_FSEL:
|
---|
4235 | case R_LSEL:
|
---|
4236 | case R_RSEL:
|
---|
4237 | case R_BEGIN_BRTAB:
|
---|
4238 | case R_END_BRTAB:
|
---|
4239 | case R_BEGIN_TRY:
|
---|
4240 | case R_N0SEL:
|
---|
4241 | case R_N1SEL:
|
---|
4242 | /* There is no symbol or addend associated with these fixups. */
|
---|
4243 | relocs[i]->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
|
---|
4244 | *relocs[i]->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (dummy_symbol);
|
---|
4245 | relocs[i]->addend = 0;
|
---|
4246 | break;
|
---|
4247 |
|
---|
4248 | case R_END_TRY:
|
---|
4249 | case R_ENTRY:
|
---|
4250 | case R_EXIT:
|
---|
4251 | /* There is no symbol associated with these fixups. */
|
---|
4252 | relocs[i]->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
|
---|
4253 | *relocs[i]->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (dummy_symbol);
|
---|
4254 | relocs[i]->addend = fixp->fx_offset;
|
---|
4255 | break;
|
---|
4256 |
|
---|
4257 | default:
|
---|
4258 | relocs[i]->addend = fixp->fx_offset;
|
---|
4259 | }
|
---|
4260 | }
|
---|
4261 |
|
---|
4262 | done:
|
---|
4263 | #endif
|
---|
4264 |
|
---|
4265 | return relocs;
|
---|
4266 | }
|
---|
4267 |
|
---|
4268 | /* Process any machine dependent frag types. */
|
---|
4269 |
|
---|
4270 | void
|
---|
4271 | md_convert_frag (abfd, sec, fragP)
|
---|
4272 | register bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
4273 | register asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
4274 | register fragS *fragP;
|
---|
4275 | {
|
---|
4276 | unsigned int address;
|
---|
4277 |
|
---|
4278 | if (fragP->fr_type == rs_machine_dependent)
|
---|
4279 | {
|
---|
4280 | switch ((int) fragP->fr_subtype)
|
---|
4281 | {
|
---|
4282 | case 0:
|
---|
4283 | fragP->fr_type = rs_fill;
|
---|
4284 | know (fragP->fr_var == 1);
|
---|
4285 | know (fragP->fr_next);
|
---|
4286 | address = fragP->fr_address + fragP->fr_fix;
|
---|
4287 | if (address % fragP->fr_offset)
|
---|
4288 | {
|
---|
4289 | fragP->fr_offset =
|
---|
4290 | fragP->fr_next->fr_address
|
---|
4291 | - fragP->fr_address
|
---|
4292 | - fragP->fr_fix;
|
---|
4293 | }
|
---|
4294 | else
|
---|
4295 | fragP->fr_offset = 0;
|
---|
4296 | break;
|
---|
4297 | }
|
---|
4298 | }
|
---|
4299 | }
|
---|
4300 |
|
---|
4301 | /* Round up a section size to the appropriate boundary. */
|
---|
4302 |
|
---|
4303 | valueT
|
---|
4304 | md_section_align (segment, size)
|
---|
4305 | asection *segment;
|
---|
4306 | valueT size;
|
---|
4307 | {
|
---|
4308 | int align = bfd_get_section_alignment (stdoutput, segment);
|
---|
4309 | int align2 = (1 << align) - 1;
|
---|
4310 |
|
---|
4311 | return (size + align2) & ~align2;
|
---|
4312 | }
|
---|
4313 |
|
---|
4314 | /* Return the approximate size of a frag before relaxation has occurred. */
|
---|
4315 | int
|
---|
4316 | md_estimate_size_before_relax (fragP, segment)
|
---|
4317 | register fragS *fragP;
|
---|
4318 | asection *segment ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
4319 | {
|
---|
4320 | int size;
|
---|
4321 |
|
---|
4322 | size = 0;
|
---|
4323 |
|
---|
4324 | while ((fragP->fr_fix + size) % fragP->fr_offset)
|
---|
4325 | size++;
|
---|
4326 |
|
---|
4327 | return size;
|
---|
4328 | }
|
---|
4329 | |
---|
4330 |
|
---|
4331 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
4332 | # ifdef WARN_COMMENTS
|
---|
4333 | const char *md_shortopts = "Vc";
|
---|
4334 | # else
|
---|
4335 | const char *md_shortopts = "V";
|
---|
4336 | # endif
|
---|
4337 | #else
|
---|
4338 | # ifdef WARN_COMMENTS
|
---|
4339 | const char *md_shortopts = "c";
|
---|
4340 | # else
|
---|
4341 | const char *md_shortopts = "";
|
---|
4342 | # endif
|
---|
4343 | #endif
|
---|
4344 |
|
---|
4345 | struct option md_longopts[] = {
|
---|
4346 | #ifdef WARN_COMMENTS
|
---|
4347 | {"warn-comment", no_argument, NULL, 'c'},
|
---|
4348 | #endif
|
---|
4349 | {NULL, no_argument, NULL, 0}
|
---|
4350 | };
|
---|
4351 | size_t md_longopts_size = sizeof (md_longopts);
|
---|
4352 |
|
---|
4353 | int
|
---|
4354 | md_parse_option (c, arg)
|
---|
4355 | int c ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
4356 | char *arg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
4357 | {
|
---|
4358 | switch (c)
|
---|
4359 | {
|
---|
4360 | default:
|
---|
4361 | return 0;
|
---|
4362 |
|
---|
4363 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
4364 | case 'V':
|
---|
4365 | print_version_id ();
|
---|
4366 | break;
|
---|
4367 | #endif
|
---|
4368 | #ifdef WARN_COMMENTS
|
---|
4369 | case 'c':
|
---|
4370 | warn_comment = 1;
|
---|
4371 | break;
|
---|
4372 | #endif
|
---|
4373 | }
|
---|
4374 |
|
---|
4375 | return 1;
|
---|
4376 | }
|
---|
4377 |
|
---|
4378 | void
|
---|
4379 | md_show_usage (stream)
|
---|
4380 | FILE *stream ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
4381 | {
|
---|
4382 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
4383 | fprintf (stream, _("\
|
---|
4384 | -Q ignored\n"));
|
---|
4385 | #endif
|
---|
4386 | #ifdef WARN_COMMENTS
|
---|
4387 | fprintf (stream, _("\
|
---|
4388 | -c print a warning if a comment is found\n"));
|
---|
4389 | #endif
|
---|
4390 | }
|
---|
4391 | |
---|
4392 |
|
---|
4393 | /* We have no need to default values of symbols. */
|
---|
4394 |
|
---|
4395 | symbolS *
|
---|
4396 | md_undefined_symbol (name)
|
---|
4397 | char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
4398 | {
|
---|
4399 | return 0;
|
---|
4400 | }
|
---|
4401 |
|
---|
4402 | #if defined (OBJ_SOM) || defined (ELF_ARG_RELOC)
|
---|
4403 | #define nonzero_dibits(x) \
|
---|
4404 | ((x) | (((x) & 0x55555555) << 1) | (((x) & 0xAAAAAAAA) >> 1))
|
---|
4405 | #define arg_reloc_stub_needed(CALLER, CALLEE) \
|
---|
4406 | (((CALLER) ^ (CALLEE)) & nonzero_dibits (CALLER) & nonzero_dibits (CALLEE))
|
---|
4407 | #else
|
---|
4408 | #define arg_reloc_stub_needed(CALLER, CALLEE) 0
|
---|
4409 | #endif
|
---|
4410 |
|
---|
4411 | /* Apply a fixup to an instruction. */
|
---|
4412 |
|
---|
4413 | void
|
---|
4414 | md_apply_fix3 (fixP, valP, seg)
|
---|
4415 | fixS *fixP;
|
---|
4416 | valueT *valP;
|
---|
4417 | segT seg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
4418 | {
|
---|
4419 | unsigned char *buf;
|
---|
4420 | struct hppa_fix_struct *hppa_fixP;
|
---|
4421 | offsetT new_val;
|
---|
4422 | int insn, val, fmt;
|
---|
4423 |
|
---|
4424 | /* SOM uses R_HPPA_ENTRY and R_HPPA_EXIT relocations which can
|
---|
4425 | never be "applied" (they are just markers). Likewise for
|
---|
4426 | R_HPPA_BEGIN_BRTAB and R_HPPA_END_BRTAB. */
|
---|
4427 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
4428 | if (fixP->fx_r_type == R_HPPA_ENTRY
|
---|
4429 | || fixP->fx_r_type == R_HPPA_EXIT
|
---|
4430 | || fixP->fx_r_type == R_HPPA_BEGIN_BRTAB
|
---|
4431 | || fixP->fx_r_type == R_HPPA_END_BRTAB
|
---|
4432 | || fixP->fx_r_type == R_HPPA_BEGIN_TRY)
|
---|
4433 | return;
|
---|
4434 |
|
---|
4435 | /* Disgusting. We must set fx_offset ourselves -- R_HPPA_END_TRY
|
---|
4436 | fixups are considered not adjustable, which in turn causes
|
---|
4437 | adjust_reloc_syms to not set fx_offset. Ugh. */
|
---|
4438 | if (fixP->fx_r_type == R_HPPA_END_TRY)
|
---|
4439 | {
|
---|
4440 | fixP->fx_offset = * valP;
|
---|
4441 | return;
|
---|
4442 | }
|
---|
4443 | #endif
|
---|
4444 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
4445 | if (fixP->fx_r_type == (int) R_PARISC_GNU_VTENTRY
|
---|
4446 | || fixP->fx_r_type == (int) R_PARISC_GNU_VTINHERIT)
|
---|
4447 | return;
|
---|
4448 | #endif
|
---|
4449 |
|
---|
4450 | if (fixP->fx_addsy == NULL && fixP->fx_pcrel == 0)
|
---|
4451 | fixP->fx_done = 1;
|
---|
4452 |
|
---|
4453 | /* There should have been an HPPA specific fixup associated
|
---|
4454 | with the GAS fixup. */
|
---|
4455 | hppa_fixP = (struct hppa_fix_struct *) fixP->tc_fix_data;
|
---|
4456 | if (hppa_fixP == NULL)
|
---|
4457 | {
|
---|
4458 | as_bad_where (fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line,
|
---|
4459 | _("no hppa_fixup entry for fixup type 0x%x"),
|
---|
4460 | fixP->fx_r_type);
|
---|
4461 | return;
|
---|
4462 | }
|
---|
4463 |
|
---|
4464 | buf = (unsigned char *) (fixP->fx_frag->fr_literal + fixP->fx_where);
|
---|
4465 | insn = bfd_get_32 (stdoutput, buf);
|
---|
4466 | fmt = bfd_hppa_insn2fmt (stdoutput, insn);
|
---|
4467 |
|
---|
4468 | /* If there is a symbol associated with this fixup, then it's something
|
---|
4469 | which will need a SOM relocation (except for some PC-relative relocs).
|
---|
4470 | In such cases we should treat the "val" or "addend" as zero since it
|
---|
4471 | will be added in as needed from fx_offset in tc_gen_reloc. */
|
---|
4472 | if ((fixP->fx_addsy != NULL
|
---|
4473 | || fixP->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_NONE)
|
---|
4474 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
4475 | && fmt != 32
|
---|
4476 | #endif
|
---|
4477 | )
|
---|
4478 | new_val = ((fmt == 12 || fmt == 17 || fmt == 22) ? 8 : 0);
|
---|
4479 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
4480 | /* These field selectors imply that we do not want an addend. */
|
---|
4481 | else if (hppa_fixP->fx_r_field == e_psel
|
---|
4482 | || hppa_fixP->fx_r_field == e_rpsel
|
---|
4483 | || hppa_fixP->fx_r_field == e_lpsel
|
---|
4484 | || hppa_fixP->fx_r_field == e_tsel
|
---|
4485 | || hppa_fixP->fx_r_field == e_rtsel
|
---|
4486 | || hppa_fixP->fx_r_field == e_ltsel)
|
---|
4487 | new_val = ((fmt == 12 || fmt == 17 || fmt == 22) ? 8 : 0);
|
---|
4488 | #endif
|
---|
4489 | else
|
---|
4490 | new_val = hppa_field_adjust (* valP, 0, hppa_fixP->fx_r_field);
|
---|
4491 |
|
---|
4492 | /* Handle pc-relative exceptions from above. */
|
---|
4493 | if ((fmt == 12 || fmt == 17 || fmt == 22)
|
---|
4494 | && fixP->fx_addsy
|
---|
4495 | && fixP->fx_pcrel
|
---|
4496 | && !arg_reloc_stub_needed (symbol_arg_reloc_info (fixP->fx_addsy),
|
---|
4497 | hppa_fixP->fx_arg_reloc)
|
---|
4498 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
4499 | && (* valP - 8 + 8192 < 16384
|
---|
4500 | || (fmt == 17 && * valP - 8 + 262144 < 524288)
|
---|
4501 | || (fmt == 22 && * valP - 8 + 8388608 < 16777216))
|
---|
4502 | #endif
|
---|
4503 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
4504 | && (* valP - 8 + 262144 < 524288
|
---|
4505 | || (fmt == 22 && * valP - 8 + 8388608 < 16777216))
|
---|
4506 | #endif
|
---|
4507 | && !S_IS_EXTERNAL (fixP->fx_addsy)
|
---|
4508 | && !S_IS_WEAK (fixP->fx_addsy)
|
---|
4509 | && S_GET_SEGMENT (fixP->fx_addsy) == hppa_fixP->segment
|
---|
4510 | && !(fixP->fx_subsy
|
---|
4511 | && S_GET_SEGMENT (fixP->fx_subsy) != hppa_fixP->segment))
|
---|
4512 | {
|
---|
4513 | new_val = hppa_field_adjust (* valP, 0, hppa_fixP->fx_r_field);
|
---|
4514 | }
|
---|
4515 |
|
---|
4516 | switch (fmt)
|
---|
4517 | {
|
---|
4518 | case 10:
|
---|
4519 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (new_val, 8191, -8192,
|
---|
4520 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4521 | val = new_val;
|
---|
4522 |
|
---|
4523 | insn = (insn & ~ 0x3ff1) | (((val & 0x1ff8) << 1)
|
---|
4524 | | ((val & 0x2000) >> 13));
|
---|
4525 | break;
|
---|
4526 | case -11:
|
---|
4527 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (new_val, 8191, -8192,
|
---|
4528 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4529 | val = new_val;
|
---|
4530 |
|
---|
4531 | insn = (insn & ~ 0x3ff9) | (((val & 0x1ffc) << 1)
|
---|
4532 | | ((val & 0x2000) >> 13));
|
---|
4533 | break;
|
---|
4534 | /* Handle all opcodes with the 'j' operand type. */
|
---|
4535 | case 14:
|
---|
4536 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (new_val, 8191, -8192,
|
---|
4537 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4538 | val = new_val;
|
---|
4539 |
|
---|
4540 | insn = ((insn & ~ 0x3fff) | low_sign_unext (val, 14));
|
---|
4541 | break;
|
---|
4542 |
|
---|
4543 | /* Handle all opcodes with the 'k' operand type. */
|
---|
4544 | case 21:
|
---|
4545 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (new_val, 1048575, -1048576,
|
---|
4546 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4547 | val = new_val;
|
---|
4548 |
|
---|
4549 | insn = (insn & ~ 0x1fffff) | re_assemble_21 (val);
|
---|
4550 | break;
|
---|
4551 |
|
---|
4552 | /* Handle all the opcodes with the 'i' operand type. */
|
---|
4553 | case 11:
|
---|
4554 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (new_val, 1023, -1024,
|
---|
4555 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4556 | val = new_val;
|
---|
4557 |
|
---|
4558 | insn = (insn & ~ 0x7ff) | low_sign_unext (val, 11);
|
---|
4559 | break;
|
---|
4560 |
|
---|
4561 | /* Handle all the opcodes with the 'w' operand type. */
|
---|
4562 | case 12:
|
---|
4563 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (new_val - 8, 8191, -8192,
|
---|
4564 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4565 | val = new_val - 8;
|
---|
4566 |
|
---|
4567 | insn = (insn & ~ 0x1ffd) | re_assemble_12 (val >> 2);
|
---|
4568 | break;
|
---|
4569 |
|
---|
4570 | /* Handle some of the opcodes with the 'W' operand type. */
|
---|
4571 | case 17:
|
---|
4572 | {
|
---|
4573 | offsetT distance = * valP;
|
---|
4574 |
|
---|
4575 | /* If this is an absolute branch (ie no link) with an out of
|
---|
4576 | range target, then we want to complain. */
|
---|
4577 | if (fixP->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL
|
---|
4578 | && (insn & 0xffe00000) == 0xe8000000)
|
---|
4579 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (distance - 8, 262143, -262144,
|
---|
4580 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4581 |
|
---|
4582 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (new_val - 8, 262143, -262144,
|
---|
4583 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4584 | val = new_val - 8;
|
---|
4585 |
|
---|
4586 | insn = (insn & ~ 0x1f1ffd) | re_assemble_17 (val >> 2);
|
---|
4587 | break;
|
---|
4588 | }
|
---|
4589 |
|
---|
4590 | case 22:
|
---|
4591 | {
|
---|
4592 | offsetT distance = * valP;
|
---|
4593 |
|
---|
4594 | /* If this is an absolute branch (ie no link) with an out of
|
---|
4595 | range target, then we want to complain. */
|
---|
4596 | if (fixP->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL
|
---|
4597 | && (insn & 0xffe00000) == 0xe8000000)
|
---|
4598 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (distance - 8, 8388607, -8388608,
|
---|
4599 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4600 |
|
---|
4601 | CHECK_FIELD_WHERE (new_val - 8, 8388607, -8388608,
|
---|
4602 | fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line);
|
---|
4603 | val = new_val - 8;
|
---|
4604 |
|
---|
4605 | insn = (insn & ~ 0x3ff1ffd) | re_assemble_22 (val >> 2);
|
---|
4606 | break;
|
---|
4607 | }
|
---|
4608 |
|
---|
4609 | case -10:
|
---|
4610 | val = new_val;
|
---|
4611 | insn = (insn & ~ 0xfff1) | re_assemble_16 (val & -8);
|
---|
4612 | break;
|
---|
4613 |
|
---|
4614 | case -16:
|
---|
4615 | val = new_val;
|
---|
4616 | insn = (insn & ~ 0xfff9) | re_assemble_16 (val & -4);
|
---|
4617 | break;
|
---|
4618 |
|
---|
4619 | case 16:
|
---|
4620 | val = new_val;
|
---|
4621 | insn = (insn & ~ 0xffff) | re_assemble_16 (val);
|
---|
4622 | break;
|
---|
4623 |
|
---|
4624 | case 32:
|
---|
4625 | insn = new_val;
|
---|
4626 | break;
|
---|
4627 |
|
---|
4628 | default:
|
---|
4629 | as_bad_where (fixP->fx_file, fixP->fx_line,
|
---|
4630 | _("Unknown relocation encountered in md_apply_fix."));
|
---|
4631 | return;
|
---|
4632 | }
|
---|
4633 |
|
---|
4634 | /* Insert the relocation. */
|
---|
4635 | bfd_put_32 (stdoutput, insn, buf);
|
---|
4636 | }
|
---|
4637 |
|
---|
4638 | /* Exactly what point is a PC-relative offset relative TO?
|
---|
4639 | On the PA, they're relative to the address of the offset. */
|
---|
4640 |
|
---|
4641 | long
|
---|
4642 | md_pcrel_from (fixP)
|
---|
4643 | fixS *fixP;
|
---|
4644 | {
|
---|
4645 | return fixP->fx_where + fixP->fx_frag->fr_address;
|
---|
4646 | }
|
---|
4647 |
|
---|
4648 | /* Return nonzero if the input line pointer is at the end of
|
---|
4649 | a statement. */
|
---|
4650 |
|
---|
4651 | static int
|
---|
4652 | is_end_of_statement ()
|
---|
4653 | {
|
---|
4654 | return ((*input_line_pointer == '\n')
|
---|
4655 | || (*input_line_pointer == ';')
|
---|
4656 | || (*input_line_pointer == '!'));
|
---|
4657 | }
|
---|
4658 |
|
---|
4659 | /* Read a number from S. The number might come in one of many forms,
|
---|
4660 | the most common will be a hex or decimal constant, but it could be
|
---|
4661 | a pre-defined register (Yuk!), or an absolute symbol.
|
---|
4662 |
|
---|
4663 | Return 1 on success or 0 on failure. If STRICT, then a missing
|
---|
4664 | register prefix will cause a failure. The number itself is
|
---|
4665 | returned in `pa_number'.
|
---|
4666 |
|
---|
4667 | IS_FLOAT indicates that a PA-89 FP register number should be
|
---|
4668 | parsed; A `l' or `r' suffix is checked for if but 2 of IS_FLOAT is
|
---|
4669 | not set.
|
---|
4670 |
|
---|
4671 | pa_parse_number can not handle negative constants and will fail
|
---|
4672 | horribly if it is passed such a constant. */
|
---|
4673 |
|
---|
4674 | static int
|
---|
4675 | pa_parse_number (s, is_float)
|
---|
4676 | char **s;
|
---|
4677 | int is_float;
|
---|
4678 | {
|
---|
4679 | int num;
|
---|
4680 | char *name;
|
---|
4681 | char c;
|
---|
4682 | symbolS *sym;
|
---|
4683 | int status;
|
---|
4684 | char *p = *s;
|
---|
4685 | bfd_boolean have_prefix;
|
---|
4686 |
|
---|
4687 | /* Skip whitespace before the number. */
|
---|
4688 | while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
|
---|
4689 | p = p + 1;
|
---|
4690 |
|
---|
4691 | pa_number = -1;
|
---|
4692 | have_prefix = 0;
|
---|
4693 | num = 0;
|
---|
4694 | if (!strict && ISDIGIT (*p))
|
---|
4695 | {
|
---|
4696 | /* Looks like a number. */
|
---|
4697 |
|
---|
4698 | if (*p == '0' && (*(p + 1) == 'x' || *(p + 1) == 'X'))
|
---|
4699 | {
|
---|
4700 | /* The number is specified in hex. */
|
---|
4701 | p += 2;
|
---|
4702 | while (ISDIGIT (*p) || ((*p >= 'a') && (*p <= 'f'))
|
---|
4703 | || ((*p >= 'A') && (*p <= 'F')))
|
---|
4704 | {
|
---|
4705 | if (ISDIGIT (*p))
|
---|
4706 | num = num * 16 + *p - '0';
|
---|
4707 | else if (*p >= 'a' && *p <= 'f')
|
---|
4708 | num = num * 16 + *p - 'a' + 10;
|
---|
4709 | else
|
---|
4710 | num = num * 16 + *p - 'A' + 10;
|
---|
4711 | ++p;
|
---|
4712 | }
|
---|
4713 | }
|
---|
4714 | else
|
---|
4715 | {
|
---|
4716 | /* The number is specified in decimal. */
|
---|
4717 | while (ISDIGIT (*p))
|
---|
4718 | {
|
---|
4719 | num = num * 10 + *p - '0';
|
---|
4720 | ++p;
|
---|
4721 | }
|
---|
4722 | }
|
---|
4723 |
|
---|
4724 | pa_number = num;
|
---|
4725 |
|
---|
4726 | /* Check for a `l' or `r' suffix. */
|
---|
4727 | if (is_float)
|
---|
4728 | {
|
---|
4729 | pa_number += FP_REG_BASE;
|
---|
4730 | if (! (is_float & 2))
|
---|
4731 | {
|
---|
4732 | if (IS_R_SELECT (p))
|
---|
4733 | {
|
---|
4734 | pa_number += FP_REG_RSEL;
|
---|
4735 | ++p;
|
---|
4736 | }
|
---|
4737 | else if (IS_L_SELECT (p))
|
---|
4738 | {
|
---|
4739 | ++p;
|
---|
4740 | }
|
---|
4741 | }
|
---|
4742 | }
|
---|
4743 | }
|
---|
4744 | else if (*p == '%')
|
---|
4745 | {
|
---|
4746 | /* The number might be a predefined register. */
|
---|
4747 | have_prefix = 1;
|
---|
4748 | name = p;
|
---|
4749 | p++;
|
---|
4750 | c = *p;
|
---|
4751 | /* Tege hack: Special case for general registers as the general
|
---|
4752 | code makes a binary search with case translation, and is VERY
|
---|
4753 | slow. */
|
---|
4754 | if (c == 'r')
|
---|
4755 | {
|
---|
4756 | p++;
|
---|
4757 | if (*p == 'e' && *(p + 1) == 't'
|
---|
4758 | && (*(p + 2) == '0' || *(p + 2) == '1'))
|
---|
4759 | {
|
---|
4760 | p += 2;
|
---|
4761 | num = *p - '0' + 28;
|
---|
4762 | p++;
|
---|
4763 | }
|
---|
4764 | else if (*p == 'p')
|
---|
4765 | {
|
---|
4766 | num = 2;
|
---|
4767 | p++;
|
---|
4768 | }
|
---|
4769 | else if (!ISDIGIT (*p))
|
---|
4770 | {
|
---|
4771 | if (print_errors)
|
---|
4772 | as_bad (_("Undefined register: '%s'."), name);
|
---|
4773 | num = -1;
|
---|
4774 | }
|
---|
4775 | else
|
---|
4776 | {
|
---|
4777 | do
|
---|
4778 | num = num * 10 + *p++ - '0';
|
---|
4779 | while (ISDIGIT (*p));
|
---|
4780 | }
|
---|
4781 | }
|
---|
4782 | else
|
---|
4783 | {
|
---|
4784 | /* Do a normal register search. */
|
---|
4785 | while (is_part_of_name (c))
|
---|
4786 | {
|
---|
4787 | p = p + 1;
|
---|
4788 | c = *p;
|
---|
4789 | }
|
---|
4790 | *p = 0;
|
---|
4791 | status = reg_name_search (name);
|
---|
4792 | if (status >= 0)
|
---|
4793 | num = status;
|
---|
4794 | else
|
---|
4795 | {
|
---|
4796 | if (print_errors)
|
---|
4797 | as_bad (_("Undefined register: '%s'."), name);
|
---|
4798 | num = -1;
|
---|
4799 | }
|
---|
4800 | *p = c;
|
---|
4801 | }
|
---|
4802 |
|
---|
4803 | pa_number = num;
|
---|
4804 | }
|
---|
4805 | else
|
---|
4806 | {
|
---|
4807 | /* And finally, it could be a symbol in the absolute section which
|
---|
4808 | is effectively a constant, or a register alias symbol. */
|
---|
4809 | name = p;
|
---|
4810 | c = *p;
|
---|
4811 | while (is_part_of_name (c))
|
---|
4812 | {
|
---|
4813 | p = p + 1;
|
---|
4814 | c = *p;
|
---|
4815 | }
|
---|
4816 | *p = 0;
|
---|
4817 | if ((sym = symbol_find (name)) != NULL)
|
---|
4818 | {
|
---|
4819 | if (S_GET_SEGMENT (sym) == reg_section)
|
---|
4820 | {
|
---|
4821 | num = S_GET_VALUE (sym);
|
---|
4822 | /* Well, we don't really have one, but we do have a
|
---|
4823 | register, so... */
|
---|
4824 | have_prefix = TRUE;
|
---|
4825 | }
|
---|
4826 | else if (S_GET_SEGMENT (sym) == &bfd_abs_section)
|
---|
4827 | num = S_GET_VALUE (sym);
|
---|
4828 | else if (!strict)
|
---|
4829 | {
|
---|
4830 | if (print_errors)
|
---|
4831 | as_bad (_("Non-absolute symbol: '%s'."), name);
|
---|
4832 | num = -1;
|
---|
4833 | }
|
---|
4834 | }
|
---|
4835 | else if (!strict)
|
---|
4836 | {
|
---|
4837 | /* There is where we'd come for an undefined symbol
|
---|
4838 | or for an empty string. For an empty string we
|
---|
4839 | will return zero. That's a concession made for
|
---|
4840 | compatability with the braindamaged HP assemblers. */
|
---|
4841 | if (*name == 0)
|
---|
4842 | num = 0;
|
---|
4843 | else
|
---|
4844 | {
|
---|
4845 | if (print_errors)
|
---|
4846 | as_bad (_("Undefined absolute constant: '%s'."), name);
|
---|
4847 | num = -1;
|
---|
4848 | }
|
---|
4849 | }
|
---|
4850 | *p = c;
|
---|
4851 |
|
---|
4852 | pa_number = num;
|
---|
4853 | }
|
---|
4854 |
|
---|
4855 | if (!strict || have_prefix)
|
---|
4856 | {
|
---|
4857 | *s = p;
|
---|
4858 | return 1;
|
---|
4859 | }
|
---|
4860 | return 0;
|
---|
4861 | }
|
---|
4862 |
|
---|
4863 | #define REG_NAME_CNT (sizeof (pre_defined_registers) / sizeof (struct pd_reg))
|
---|
4864 |
|
---|
4865 | /* Given NAME, find the register number associated with that name, return
|
---|
4866 | the integer value associated with the given name or -1 on failure. */
|
---|
4867 |
|
---|
4868 | static int
|
---|
4869 | reg_name_search (name)
|
---|
4870 | char *name;
|
---|
4871 | {
|
---|
4872 | int middle, low, high;
|
---|
4873 | int cmp;
|
---|
4874 |
|
---|
4875 | low = 0;
|
---|
4876 | high = REG_NAME_CNT - 1;
|
---|
4877 |
|
---|
4878 | do
|
---|
4879 | {
|
---|
4880 | middle = (low + high) / 2;
|
---|
4881 | cmp = strcasecmp (name, pre_defined_registers[middle].name);
|
---|
4882 | if (cmp < 0)
|
---|
4883 | high = middle - 1;
|
---|
4884 | else if (cmp > 0)
|
---|
4885 | low = middle + 1;
|
---|
4886 | else
|
---|
4887 | return pre_defined_registers[middle].value;
|
---|
4888 | }
|
---|
4889 | while (low <= high);
|
---|
4890 |
|
---|
4891 | return -1;
|
---|
4892 | }
|
---|
4893 |
|
---|
4894 | /* Return nonzero if the given INSN and L/R information will require
|
---|
4895 | a new PA-1.1 opcode. */
|
---|
4896 |
|
---|
4897 | static int
|
---|
4898 | need_pa11_opcode ()
|
---|
4899 | {
|
---|
4900 | if ((pa_number & FP_REG_RSEL) != 0
|
---|
4901 | && !(the_insn.fpof1 == DBL && the_insn.fpof2 == DBL))
|
---|
4902 | {
|
---|
4903 | /* If this instruction is specific to a particular architecture,
|
---|
4904 | then set a new architecture. */
|
---|
4905 | if (bfd_get_mach (stdoutput) < pa11)
|
---|
4906 | {
|
---|
4907 | if (!bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_hppa, pa11))
|
---|
4908 | as_warn (_("could not update architecture and machine"));
|
---|
4909 | }
|
---|
4910 | return TRUE;
|
---|
4911 | }
|
---|
4912 | else
|
---|
4913 | return FALSE;
|
---|
4914 | }
|
---|
4915 |
|
---|
4916 | /* Parse a condition for a fcmp instruction. Return the numerical
|
---|
4917 | code associated with the condition. */
|
---|
4918 |
|
---|
4919 | static int
|
---|
4920 | pa_parse_fp_cmp_cond (s)
|
---|
4921 | char **s;
|
---|
4922 | {
|
---|
4923 | int cond, i;
|
---|
4924 |
|
---|
4925 | cond = 0;
|
---|
4926 |
|
---|
4927 | for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
|
---|
4928 | {
|
---|
4929 | if (strncasecmp (*s, fp_cond_map[i].string,
|
---|
4930 | strlen (fp_cond_map[i].string)) == 0)
|
---|
4931 | {
|
---|
4932 | cond = fp_cond_map[i].cond;
|
---|
4933 | *s += strlen (fp_cond_map[i].string);
|
---|
4934 | /* If not a complete match, back up the input string and
|
---|
4935 | report an error. */
|
---|
4936 | if (**s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
4937 | {
|
---|
4938 | *s -= strlen (fp_cond_map[i].string);
|
---|
4939 | break;
|
---|
4940 | }
|
---|
4941 | while (**s == ' ' || **s == '\t')
|
---|
4942 | *s = *s + 1;
|
---|
4943 | return cond;
|
---|
4944 | }
|
---|
4945 | }
|
---|
4946 |
|
---|
4947 | as_bad (_("Invalid FP Compare Condition: %s"), *s);
|
---|
4948 |
|
---|
4949 | /* Advance over the bogus completer. */
|
---|
4950 | while (**s != ',' && **s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
4951 | *s += 1;
|
---|
4952 |
|
---|
4953 | return 0;
|
---|
4954 | }
|
---|
4955 |
|
---|
4956 | /* Parse a graphics test complete for ftest. */
|
---|
4957 |
|
---|
4958 | static int
|
---|
4959 | pa_parse_ftest_gfx_completer (s)
|
---|
4960 | char **s;
|
---|
4961 | {
|
---|
4962 | int value;
|
---|
4963 |
|
---|
4964 | value = 0;
|
---|
4965 | if (strncasecmp (*s, "acc8", 4) == 0)
|
---|
4966 | {
|
---|
4967 | value = 5;
|
---|
4968 | *s += 4;
|
---|
4969 | }
|
---|
4970 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "acc6", 4) == 0)
|
---|
4971 | {
|
---|
4972 | value = 9;
|
---|
4973 | *s += 4;
|
---|
4974 | }
|
---|
4975 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "acc4", 4) == 0)
|
---|
4976 | {
|
---|
4977 | value = 13;
|
---|
4978 | *s += 4;
|
---|
4979 | }
|
---|
4980 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "acc2", 4) == 0)
|
---|
4981 | {
|
---|
4982 | value = 17;
|
---|
4983 | *s += 4;
|
---|
4984 | }
|
---|
4985 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "acc", 3) == 0)
|
---|
4986 | {
|
---|
4987 | value = 1;
|
---|
4988 | *s += 3;
|
---|
4989 | }
|
---|
4990 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "rej8", 4) == 0)
|
---|
4991 | {
|
---|
4992 | value = 6;
|
---|
4993 | *s += 4;
|
---|
4994 | }
|
---|
4995 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "rej", 3) == 0)
|
---|
4996 | {
|
---|
4997 | value = 2;
|
---|
4998 | *s += 3;
|
---|
4999 | }
|
---|
5000 | else
|
---|
5001 | {
|
---|
5002 | value = 0;
|
---|
5003 | as_bad (_("Invalid FTEST completer: %s"), *s);
|
---|
5004 | }
|
---|
5005 |
|
---|
5006 | return value;
|
---|
5007 | }
|
---|
5008 |
|
---|
5009 | /* Parse an FP operand format completer returning the completer
|
---|
5010 | type. */
|
---|
5011 |
|
---|
5012 | static fp_operand_format
|
---|
5013 | pa_parse_fp_cnv_format (s)
|
---|
5014 | char **s;
|
---|
5015 | {
|
---|
5016 | int format;
|
---|
5017 |
|
---|
5018 | format = SGL;
|
---|
5019 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5020 | {
|
---|
5021 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5022 | if (strncasecmp (*s, "sgl", 3) == 0)
|
---|
5023 | {
|
---|
5024 | format = SGL;
|
---|
5025 | *s += 4;
|
---|
5026 | }
|
---|
5027 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "dbl", 3) == 0)
|
---|
5028 | {
|
---|
5029 | format = DBL;
|
---|
5030 | *s += 4;
|
---|
5031 | }
|
---|
5032 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "quad", 4) == 0)
|
---|
5033 | {
|
---|
5034 | format = QUAD;
|
---|
5035 | *s += 5;
|
---|
5036 | }
|
---|
5037 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "w", 1) == 0)
|
---|
5038 | {
|
---|
5039 | format = W;
|
---|
5040 | *s += 2;
|
---|
5041 | }
|
---|
5042 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "uw", 2) == 0)
|
---|
5043 | {
|
---|
5044 | format = UW;
|
---|
5045 | *s += 3;
|
---|
5046 | }
|
---|
5047 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "dw", 2) == 0)
|
---|
5048 | {
|
---|
5049 | format = DW;
|
---|
5050 | *s += 3;
|
---|
5051 | }
|
---|
5052 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "udw", 3) == 0)
|
---|
5053 | {
|
---|
5054 | format = UDW;
|
---|
5055 | *s += 4;
|
---|
5056 | }
|
---|
5057 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "qw", 2) == 0)
|
---|
5058 | {
|
---|
5059 | format = QW;
|
---|
5060 | *s += 3;
|
---|
5061 | }
|
---|
5062 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "uqw", 3) == 0)
|
---|
5063 | {
|
---|
5064 | format = UQW;
|
---|
5065 | *s += 4;
|
---|
5066 | }
|
---|
5067 | else
|
---|
5068 | {
|
---|
5069 | format = ILLEGAL_FMT;
|
---|
5070 | as_bad (_("Invalid FP Operand Format: %3s"), *s);
|
---|
5071 | }
|
---|
5072 | }
|
---|
5073 |
|
---|
5074 | return format;
|
---|
5075 | }
|
---|
5076 |
|
---|
5077 | /* Parse an FP operand format completer returning the completer
|
---|
5078 | type. */
|
---|
5079 |
|
---|
5080 | static fp_operand_format
|
---|
5081 | pa_parse_fp_format (s)
|
---|
5082 | char **s;
|
---|
5083 | {
|
---|
5084 | int format;
|
---|
5085 |
|
---|
5086 | format = SGL;
|
---|
5087 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5088 | {
|
---|
5089 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5090 | if (strncasecmp (*s, "sgl", 3) == 0)
|
---|
5091 | {
|
---|
5092 | format = SGL;
|
---|
5093 | *s += 4;
|
---|
5094 | }
|
---|
5095 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "dbl", 3) == 0)
|
---|
5096 | {
|
---|
5097 | format = DBL;
|
---|
5098 | *s += 4;
|
---|
5099 | }
|
---|
5100 | else if (strncasecmp (*s, "quad", 4) == 0)
|
---|
5101 | {
|
---|
5102 | format = QUAD;
|
---|
5103 | *s += 5;
|
---|
5104 | }
|
---|
5105 | else
|
---|
5106 | {
|
---|
5107 | format = ILLEGAL_FMT;
|
---|
5108 | as_bad (_("Invalid FP Operand Format: %3s"), *s);
|
---|
5109 | }
|
---|
5110 | }
|
---|
5111 |
|
---|
5112 | return format;
|
---|
5113 | }
|
---|
5114 |
|
---|
5115 | /* Convert from a selector string into a selector type. */
|
---|
5116 |
|
---|
5117 | static int
|
---|
5118 | pa_chk_field_selector (str)
|
---|
5119 | char **str;
|
---|
5120 | {
|
---|
5121 | int middle, low, high;
|
---|
5122 | int cmp;
|
---|
5123 | char name[4];
|
---|
5124 |
|
---|
5125 | /* Read past any whitespace. */
|
---|
5126 | /* FIXME: should we read past newlines and formfeeds??? */
|
---|
5127 | while (**str == ' ' || **str == '\t' || **str == '\n' || **str == '\f')
|
---|
5128 | *str = *str + 1;
|
---|
5129 |
|
---|
5130 | if ((*str)[1] == '\'' || (*str)[1] == '%')
|
---|
5131 | name[0] = TOLOWER ((*str)[0]),
|
---|
5132 | name[1] = 0;
|
---|
5133 | else if ((*str)[2] == '\'' || (*str)[2] == '%')
|
---|
5134 | name[0] = TOLOWER ((*str)[0]),
|
---|
5135 | name[1] = TOLOWER ((*str)[1]),
|
---|
5136 | name[2] = 0;
|
---|
5137 | else if ((*str)[3] == '\'' || (*str)[3] == '%')
|
---|
5138 | name[0] = TOLOWER ((*str)[0]),
|
---|
5139 | name[1] = TOLOWER ((*str)[1]),
|
---|
5140 | name[2] = TOLOWER ((*str)[2]),
|
---|
5141 | name[3] = 0;
|
---|
5142 | else
|
---|
5143 | return e_fsel;
|
---|
5144 |
|
---|
5145 | low = 0;
|
---|
5146 | high = sizeof (selector_table) / sizeof (struct selector_entry) - 1;
|
---|
5147 |
|
---|
5148 | do
|
---|
5149 | {
|
---|
5150 | middle = (low + high) / 2;
|
---|
5151 | cmp = strcmp (name, selector_table[middle].prefix);
|
---|
5152 | if (cmp < 0)
|
---|
5153 | high = middle - 1;
|
---|
5154 | else if (cmp > 0)
|
---|
5155 | low = middle + 1;
|
---|
5156 | else
|
---|
5157 | {
|
---|
5158 | *str += strlen (name) + 1;
|
---|
5159 | #ifndef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
5160 | if (selector_table[middle].field_selector == e_nsel)
|
---|
5161 | return e_fsel;
|
---|
5162 | #endif
|
---|
5163 | return selector_table[middle].field_selector;
|
---|
5164 | }
|
---|
5165 | }
|
---|
5166 | while (low <= high);
|
---|
5167 |
|
---|
5168 | return e_fsel;
|
---|
5169 | }
|
---|
5170 |
|
---|
5171 | /* Mark (via expr_end) the end of an expression (I think). FIXME. */
|
---|
5172 |
|
---|
5173 | static int
|
---|
5174 | get_expression (str)
|
---|
5175 | char *str;
|
---|
5176 | {
|
---|
5177 | char *save_in;
|
---|
5178 | asection *seg;
|
---|
5179 |
|
---|
5180 | save_in = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
5181 | input_line_pointer = str;
|
---|
5182 | seg = expression (&the_insn.exp);
|
---|
5183 | if (!(seg == absolute_section
|
---|
5184 | || seg == undefined_section
|
---|
5185 | || SEG_NORMAL (seg)))
|
---|
5186 | {
|
---|
5187 | as_warn (_("Bad segment in expression."));
|
---|
5188 | expr_end = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
5189 | input_line_pointer = save_in;
|
---|
5190 | return 1;
|
---|
5191 | }
|
---|
5192 | expr_end = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
5193 | input_line_pointer = save_in;
|
---|
5194 | return 0;
|
---|
5195 | }
|
---|
5196 |
|
---|
5197 | /* Mark (via expr_end) the end of an absolute expression. FIXME. */
|
---|
5198 | static int
|
---|
5199 | pa_get_absolute_expression (insn, strp)
|
---|
5200 | struct pa_it *insn;
|
---|
5201 | char **strp;
|
---|
5202 | {
|
---|
5203 | char *save_in;
|
---|
5204 |
|
---|
5205 | insn->field_selector = pa_chk_field_selector (strp);
|
---|
5206 | save_in = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
5207 | input_line_pointer = *strp;
|
---|
5208 | expression (&insn->exp);
|
---|
5209 | /* This is not perfect, but is a huge improvement over doing nothing.
|
---|
5210 |
|
---|
5211 | The PA assembly syntax is ambigious in a variety of ways. Consider
|
---|
5212 | this string "4 %r5" Is that the number 4 followed by the register
|
---|
5213 | r5, or is that 4 MOD r5?
|
---|
5214 |
|
---|
5215 | If we get a modulo expresion When looking for an absolute, we try
|
---|
5216 | again cutting off the input string at the first whitespace character. */
|
---|
5217 | if (insn->exp.X_op == O_modulus)
|
---|
5218 | {
|
---|
5219 | char *s, c;
|
---|
5220 | int retval;
|
---|
5221 |
|
---|
5222 | input_line_pointer = *strp;
|
---|
5223 | s = *strp;
|
---|
5224 | while (*s != ',' && *s != ' ' && *s != '\t')
|
---|
5225 | s++;
|
---|
5226 |
|
---|
5227 | c = *s;
|
---|
5228 | *s = 0;
|
---|
5229 |
|
---|
5230 | retval = pa_get_absolute_expression (insn, strp);
|
---|
5231 |
|
---|
5232 | input_line_pointer = save_in;
|
---|
5233 | *s = c;
|
---|
5234 | return evaluate_absolute (insn);
|
---|
5235 | }
|
---|
5236 | /* When in strict mode we have a non-match, fix up the pointers
|
---|
5237 | and return to our caller. */
|
---|
5238 | if (insn->exp.X_op != O_constant && strict)
|
---|
5239 | {
|
---|
5240 | expr_end = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
5241 | input_line_pointer = save_in;
|
---|
5242 | return 0;
|
---|
5243 | }
|
---|
5244 | if (insn->exp.X_op != O_constant)
|
---|
5245 | {
|
---|
5246 | as_bad (_("Bad segment (should be absolute)."));
|
---|
5247 | expr_end = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
5248 | input_line_pointer = save_in;
|
---|
5249 | return 0;
|
---|
5250 | }
|
---|
5251 | expr_end = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
5252 | input_line_pointer = save_in;
|
---|
5253 | return evaluate_absolute (insn);
|
---|
5254 | }
|
---|
5255 |
|
---|
5256 | /* Evaluate an absolute expression EXP which may be modified by
|
---|
5257 | the selector FIELD_SELECTOR. Return the value of the expression. */
|
---|
5258 | static int
|
---|
5259 | evaluate_absolute (insn)
|
---|
5260 | struct pa_it *insn;
|
---|
5261 | {
|
---|
5262 | offsetT value;
|
---|
5263 | expressionS exp;
|
---|
5264 | int field_selector = insn->field_selector;
|
---|
5265 |
|
---|
5266 | exp = insn->exp;
|
---|
5267 | value = exp.X_add_number;
|
---|
5268 |
|
---|
5269 | return hppa_field_adjust (0, value, field_selector);
|
---|
5270 | }
|
---|
5271 |
|
---|
5272 | /* Given an argument location specification return the associated
|
---|
5273 | argument location number. */
|
---|
5274 |
|
---|
5275 | static unsigned int
|
---|
5276 | pa_build_arg_reloc (type_name)
|
---|
5277 | char *type_name;
|
---|
5278 | {
|
---|
5279 |
|
---|
5280 | if (strncasecmp (type_name, "no", 2) == 0)
|
---|
5281 | return 0;
|
---|
5282 | if (strncasecmp (type_name, "gr", 2) == 0)
|
---|
5283 | return 1;
|
---|
5284 | else if (strncasecmp (type_name, "fr", 2) == 0)
|
---|
5285 | return 2;
|
---|
5286 | else if (strncasecmp (type_name, "fu", 2) == 0)
|
---|
5287 | return 3;
|
---|
5288 | else
|
---|
5289 | as_bad (_("Invalid argument location: %s\n"), type_name);
|
---|
5290 |
|
---|
5291 | return 0;
|
---|
5292 | }
|
---|
5293 |
|
---|
5294 | /* Encode and return an argument relocation specification for
|
---|
5295 | the given register in the location specified by arg_reloc. */
|
---|
5296 |
|
---|
5297 | static unsigned int
|
---|
5298 | pa_align_arg_reloc (reg, arg_reloc)
|
---|
5299 | unsigned int reg;
|
---|
5300 | unsigned int arg_reloc;
|
---|
5301 | {
|
---|
5302 | unsigned int new_reloc;
|
---|
5303 |
|
---|
5304 | new_reloc = arg_reloc;
|
---|
5305 | switch (reg)
|
---|
5306 | {
|
---|
5307 | case 0:
|
---|
5308 | new_reloc <<= 8;
|
---|
5309 | break;
|
---|
5310 | case 1:
|
---|
5311 | new_reloc <<= 6;
|
---|
5312 | break;
|
---|
5313 | case 2:
|
---|
5314 | new_reloc <<= 4;
|
---|
5315 | break;
|
---|
5316 | case 3:
|
---|
5317 | new_reloc <<= 2;
|
---|
5318 | break;
|
---|
5319 | default:
|
---|
5320 | as_bad (_("Invalid argument description: %d"), reg);
|
---|
5321 | }
|
---|
5322 |
|
---|
5323 | return new_reloc;
|
---|
5324 | }
|
---|
5325 |
|
---|
5326 | /* Parse a PA nullification completer (,n). Return nonzero if the
|
---|
5327 | completer was found; return zero if no completer was found. */
|
---|
5328 |
|
---|
5329 | static int
|
---|
5330 | pa_parse_nullif (s)
|
---|
5331 | char **s;
|
---|
5332 | {
|
---|
5333 | int nullif;
|
---|
5334 |
|
---|
5335 | nullif = 0;
|
---|
5336 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5337 | {
|
---|
5338 | *s = *s + 1;
|
---|
5339 | if (strncasecmp (*s, "n", 1) == 0)
|
---|
5340 | nullif = 1;
|
---|
5341 | else
|
---|
5342 | {
|
---|
5343 | as_bad (_("Invalid Nullification: (%c)"), **s);
|
---|
5344 | nullif = 0;
|
---|
5345 | }
|
---|
5346 | *s = *s + 1;
|
---|
5347 | }
|
---|
5348 |
|
---|
5349 | return nullif;
|
---|
5350 | }
|
---|
5351 |
|
---|
5352 | /* Parse a non-negated compare/subtract completer returning the
|
---|
5353 | number (for encoding in instrutions) of the given completer. */
|
---|
5354 |
|
---|
5355 | static int
|
---|
5356 | pa_parse_nonneg_cmpsub_cmpltr (s)
|
---|
5357 | char **s;
|
---|
5358 | {
|
---|
5359 | int cmpltr;
|
---|
5360 | char *name = *s + 1;
|
---|
5361 | char c;
|
---|
5362 | char *save_s = *s;
|
---|
5363 | int nullify = 0;
|
---|
5364 |
|
---|
5365 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5366 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5367 | {
|
---|
5368 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5369 | while (**s != ',' && **s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
5370 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5371 | c = **s;
|
---|
5372 | **s = 0x00;
|
---|
5373 |
|
---|
5374 | if (strcmp (name, "=") == 0)
|
---|
5375 | {
|
---|
5376 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
5377 | }
|
---|
5378 | else if (strcmp (name, "<") == 0)
|
---|
5379 | {
|
---|
5380 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
5381 | }
|
---|
5382 | else if (strcmp (name, "<=") == 0)
|
---|
5383 | {
|
---|
5384 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
5385 | }
|
---|
5386 | else if (strcmp (name, "<<") == 0)
|
---|
5387 | {
|
---|
5388 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
5389 | }
|
---|
5390 | else if (strcmp (name, "<<=") == 0)
|
---|
5391 | {
|
---|
5392 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
5393 | }
|
---|
5394 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "sv") == 0)
|
---|
5395 | {
|
---|
5396 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
5397 | }
|
---|
5398 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "od") == 0)
|
---|
5399 | {
|
---|
5400 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
5401 | }
|
---|
5402 | /* If we have something like addb,n then there is no condition
|
---|
5403 | completer. */
|
---|
5404 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "n") == 0)
|
---|
5405 | {
|
---|
5406 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5407 | nullify = 1;
|
---|
5408 | }
|
---|
5409 | else
|
---|
5410 | {
|
---|
5411 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5412 | }
|
---|
5413 | **s = c;
|
---|
5414 | }
|
---|
5415 |
|
---|
5416 | /* Reset pointers if this was really a ,n for a branch instruction. */
|
---|
5417 | if (nullify)
|
---|
5418 | *s = save_s;
|
---|
5419 |
|
---|
5420 | return cmpltr;
|
---|
5421 | }
|
---|
5422 |
|
---|
5423 | /* Parse a negated compare/subtract completer returning the
|
---|
5424 | number (for encoding in instrutions) of the given completer. */
|
---|
5425 |
|
---|
5426 | static int
|
---|
5427 | pa_parse_neg_cmpsub_cmpltr (s)
|
---|
5428 | char **s;
|
---|
5429 | {
|
---|
5430 | int cmpltr;
|
---|
5431 | char *name = *s + 1;
|
---|
5432 | char c;
|
---|
5433 | char *save_s = *s;
|
---|
5434 | int nullify = 0;
|
---|
5435 |
|
---|
5436 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5437 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5438 | {
|
---|
5439 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5440 | while (**s != ',' && **s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
5441 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5442 | c = **s;
|
---|
5443 | **s = 0x00;
|
---|
5444 |
|
---|
5445 | if (strcasecmp (name, "tr") == 0)
|
---|
5446 | {
|
---|
5447 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5448 | }
|
---|
5449 | else if (strcmp (name, "<>") == 0)
|
---|
5450 | {
|
---|
5451 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
5452 | }
|
---|
5453 | else if (strcmp (name, ">=") == 0)
|
---|
5454 | {
|
---|
5455 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
5456 | }
|
---|
5457 | else if (strcmp (name, ">") == 0)
|
---|
5458 | {
|
---|
5459 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
5460 | }
|
---|
5461 | else if (strcmp (name, ">>=") == 0)
|
---|
5462 | {
|
---|
5463 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
5464 | }
|
---|
5465 | else if (strcmp (name, ">>") == 0)
|
---|
5466 | {
|
---|
5467 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
5468 | }
|
---|
5469 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "nsv") == 0)
|
---|
5470 | {
|
---|
5471 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
5472 | }
|
---|
5473 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "ev") == 0)
|
---|
5474 | {
|
---|
5475 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
5476 | }
|
---|
5477 | /* If we have something like addb,n then there is no condition
|
---|
5478 | completer. */
|
---|
5479 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "n") == 0)
|
---|
5480 | {
|
---|
5481 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5482 | nullify = 1;
|
---|
5483 | }
|
---|
5484 | else
|
---|
5485 | {
|
---|
5486 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5487 | }
|
---|
5488 | **s = c;
|
---|
5489 | }
|
---|
5490 |
|
---|
5491 | /* Reset pointers if this was really a ,n for a branch instruction. */
|
---|
5492 | if (nullify)
|
---|
5493 | *s = save_s;
|
---|
5494 |
|
---|
5495 | return cmpltr;
|
---|
5496 | }
|
---|
5497 |
|
---|
5498 | /* Parse a 64 bit compare and branch completer returning the number (for
|
---|
5499 | encoding in instrutions) of the given completer.
|
---|
5500 |
|
---|
5501 | Nonnegated comparisons are returned as 0-7, negated comparisons are
|
---|
5502 | returned as 8-15. */
|
---|
5503 |
|
---|
5504 | static int
|
---|
5505 | pa_parse_cmpb_64_cmpltr (s)
|
---|
5506 | char **s;
|
---|
5507 | {
|
---|
5508 | int cmpltr;
|
---|
5509 | char *name = *s + 1;
|
---|
5510 | char c;
|
---|
5511 |
|
---|
5512 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5513 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5514 | {
|
---|
5515 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5516 | while (**s != ',' && **s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
5517 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5518 | c = **s;
|
---|
5519 | **s = 0x00;
|
---|
5520 |
|
---|
5521 | if (strcmp (name, "*") == 0)
|
---|
5522 | {
|
---|
5523 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5524 | }
|
---|
5525 | else if (strcmp (name, "*=") == 0)
|
---|
5526 | {
|
---|
5527 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
5528 | }
|
---|
5529 | else if (strcmp (name, "*<") == 0)
|
---|
5530 | {
|
---|
5531 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
5532 | }
|
---|
5533 | else if (strcmp (name, "*<=") == 0)
|
---|
5534 | {
|
---|
5535 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
5536 | }
|
---|
5537 | else if (strcmp (name, "*<<") == 0)
|
---|
5538 | {
|
---|
5539 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
5540 | }
|
---|
5541 | else if (strcmp (name, "*<<=") == 0)
|
---|
5542 | {
|
---|
5543 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
5544 | }
|
---|
5545 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*sv") == 0)
|
---|
5546 | {
|
---|
5547 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
5548 | }
|
---|
5549 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*od") == 0)
|
---|
5550 | {
|
---|
5551 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
5552 | }
|
---|
5553 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*tr") == 0)
|
---|
5554 | {
|
---|
5555 | cmpltr = 8;
|
---|
5556 | }
|
---|
5557 | else if (strcmp (name, "*<>") == 0)
|
---|
5558 | {
|
---|
5559 | cmpltr = 9;
|
---|
5560 | }
|
---|
5561 | else if (strcmp (name, "*>=") == 0)
|
---|
5562 | {
|
---|
5563 | cmpltr = 10;
|
---|
5564 | }
|
---|
5565 | else if (strcmp (name, "*>") == 0)
|
---|
5566 | {
|
---|
5567 | cmpltr = 11;
|
---|
5568 | }
|
---|
5569 | else if (strcmp (name, "*>>=") == 0)
|
---|
5570 | {
|
---|
5571 | cmpltr = 12;
|
---|
5572 | }
|
---|
5573 | else if (strcmp (name, "*>>") == 0)
|
---|
5574 | {
|
---|
5575 | cmpltr = 13;
|
---|
5576 | }
|
---|
5577 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*nsv") == 0)
|
---|
5578 | {
|
---|
5579 | cmpltr = 14;
|
---|
5580 | }
|
---|
5581 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*ev") == 0)
|
---|
5582 | {
|
---|
5583 | cmpltr = 15;
|
---|
5584 | }
|
---|
5585 | else
|
---|
5586 | {
|
---|
5587 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5588 | }
|
---|
5589 | **s = c;
|
---|
5590 | }
|
---|
5591 |
|
---|
5592 | return cmpltr;
|
---|
5593 | }
|
---|
5594 |
|
---|
5595 | /* Parse a 64 bit compare immediate and branch completer returning the number
|
---|
5596 | (for encoding in instrutions) of the given completer. */
|
---|
5597 |
|
---|
5598 | static int
|
---|
5599 | pa_parse_cmpib_64_cmpltr (s)
|
---|
5600 | char **s;
|
---|
5601 | {
|
---|
5602 | int cmpltr;
|
---|
5603 | char *name = *s + 1;
|
---|
5604 | char c;
|
---|
5605 |
|
---|
5606 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5607 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5608 | {
|
---|
5609 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5610 | while (**s != ',' && **s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
5611 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5612 | c = **s;
|
---|
5613 | **s = 0x00;
|
---|
5614 |
|
---|
5615 | if (strcmp (name, "*<<") == 0)
|
---|
5616 | {
|
---|
5617 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5618 | }
|
---|
5619 | else if (strcmp (name, "*=") == 0)
|
---|
5620 | {
|
---|
5621 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
5622 | }
|
---|
5623 | else if (strcmp (name, "*<") == 0)
|
---|
5624 | {
|
---|
5625 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
5626 | }
|
---|
5627 | else if (strcmp (name, "*<=") == 0)
|
---|
5628 | {
|
---|
5629 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
5630 | }
|
---|
5631 | else if (strcmp (name, "*>>=") == 0)
|
---|
5632 | {
|
---|
5633 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
5634 | }
|
---|
5635 | else if (strcmp (name, "*<>") == 0)
|
---|
5636 | {
|
---|
5637 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
5638 | }
|
---|
5639 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*>=") == 0)
|
---|
5640 | {
|
---|
5641 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
5642 | }
|
---|
5643 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*>") == 0)
|
---|
5644 | {
|
---|
5645 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
5646 | }
|
---|
5647 | else
|
---|
5648 | {
|
---|
5649 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5650 | }
|
---|
5651 | **s = c;
|
---|
5652 | }
|
---|
5653 |
|
---|
5654 | return cmpltr;
|
---|
5655 | }
|
---|
5656 |
|
---|
5657 | /* Parse a non-negated addition completer returning the number
|
---|
5658 | (for encoding in instrutions) of the given completer. */
|
---|
5659 |
|
---|
5660 | static int
|
---|
5661 | pa_parse_nonneg_add_cmpltr (s)
|
---|
5662 | char **s;
|
---|
5663 | {
|
---|
5664 | int cmpltr;
|
---|
5665 | char *name = *s + 1;
|
---|
5666 | char c;
|
---|
5667 | char *save_s = *s;
|
---|
5668 | int nullify = 0;
|
---|
5669 |
|
---|
5670 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5671 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5672 | {
|
---|
5673 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5674 | while (**s != ',' && **s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
5675 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5676 | c = **s;
|
---|
5677 | **s = 0x00;
|
---|
5678 | if (strcmp (name, "=") == 0)
|
---|
5679 | {
|
---|
5680 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
5681 | }
|
---|
5682 | else if (strcmp (name, "<") == 0)
|
---|
5683 | {
|
---|
5684 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
5685 | }
|
---|
5686 | else if (strcmp (name, "<=") == 0)
|
---|
5687 | {
|
---|
5688 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
5689 | }
|
---|
5690 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "nuv") == 0)
|
---|
5691 | {
|
---|
5692 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
5693 | }
|
---|
5694 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "znv") == 0)
|
---|
5695 | {
|
---|
5696 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
5697 | }
|
---|
5698 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "sv") == 0)
|
---|
5699 | {
|
---|
5700 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
5701 | }
|
---|
5702 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "od") == 0)
|
---|
5703 | {
|
---|
5704 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
5705 | }
|
---|
5706 | /* If we have something like addb,n then there is no condition
|
---|
5707 | completer. */
|
---|
5708 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "n") == 0)
|
---|
5709 | {
|
---|
5710 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5711 | nullify = 1;
|
---|
5712 | }
|
---|
5713 | else
|
---|
5714 | {
|
---|
5715 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5716 | }
|
---|
5717 | **s = c;
|
---|
5718 | }
|
---|
5719 |
|
---|
5720 | /* Reset pointers if this was really a ,n for a branch instruction. */
|
---|
5721 | if (nullify)
|
---|
5722 | *s = save_s;
|
---|
5723 |
|
---|
5724 | return cmpltr;
|
---|
5725 | }
|
---|
5726 |
|
---|
5727 | /* Parse a negated addition completer returning the number
|
---|
5728 | (for encoding in instrutions) of the given completer. */
|
---|
5729 |
|
---|
5730 | static int
|
---|
5731 | pa_parse_neg_add_cmpltr (s)
|
---|
5732 | char **s;
|
---|
5733 | {
|
---|
5734 | int cmpltr;
|
---|
5735 | char *name = *s + 1;
|
---|
5736 | char c;
|
---|
5737 | char *save_s = *s;
|
---|
5738 | int nullify = 0;
|
---|
5739 |
|
---|
5740 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5741 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5742 | {
|
---|
5743 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5744 | while (**s != ',' && **s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
5745 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5746 | c = **s;
|
---|
5747 | **s = 0x00;
|
---|
5748 | if (strcasecmp (name, "tr") == 0)
|
---|
5749 | {
|
---|
5750 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5751 | }
|
---|
5752 | else if (strcmp (name, "<>") == 0)
|
---|
5753 | {
|
---|
5754 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
5755 | }
|
---|
5756 | else if (strcmp (name, ">=") == 0)
|
---|
5757 | {
|
---|
5758 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
5759 | }
|
---|
5760 | else if (strcmp (name, ">") == 0)
|
---|
5761 | {
|
---|
5762 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
5763 | }
|
---|
5764 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "uv") == 0)
|
---|
5765 | {
|
---|
5766 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
5767 | }
|
---|
5768 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "vnz") == 0)
|
---|
5769 | {
|
---|
5770 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
5771 | }
|
---|
5772 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "nsv") == 0)
|
---|
5773 | {
|
---|
5774 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
5775 | }
|
---|
5776 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "ev") == 0)
|
---|
5777 | {
|
---|
5778 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
5779 | }
|
---|
5780 | /* If we have something like addb,n then there is no condition
|
---|
5781 | completer. */
|
---|
5782 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "n") == 0)
|
---|
5783 | {
|
---|
5784 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5785 | nullify = 1;
|
---|
5786 | }
|
---|
5787 | else
|
---|
5788 | {
|
---|
5789 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5790 | }
|
---|
5791 | **s = c;
|
---|
5792 | }
|
---|
5793 |
|
---|
5794 | /* Reset pointers if this was really a ,n for a branch instruction. */
|
---|
5795 | if (nullify)
|
---|
5796 | *s = save_s;
|
---|
5797 |
|
---|
5798 | return cmpltr;
|
---|
5799 | }
|
---|
5800 |
|
---|
5801 | /* Parse a 64 bit wide mode add and branch completer returning the number (for
|
---|
5802 | encoding in instrutions) of the given completer. */
|
---|
5803 |
|
---|
5804 | static int
|
---|
5805 | pa_parse_addb_64_cmpltr (s)
|
---|
5806 | char **s;
|
---|
5807 | {
|
---|
5808 | int cmpltr;
|
---|
5809 | char *name = *s + 1;
|
---|
5810 | char c;
|
---|
5811 | char *save_s = *s;
|
---|
5812 | int nullify = 0;
|
---|
5813 |
|
---|
5814 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5815 | if (**s == ',')
|
---|
5816 | {
|
---|
5817 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5818 | while (**s != ',' && **s != ' ' && **s != '\t')
|
---|
5819 | *s += 1;
|
---|
5820 | c = **s;
|
---|
5821 | **s = 0x00;
|
---|
5822 | if (strcmp (name, "=") == 0)
|
---|
5823 | {
|
---|
5824 | cmpltr = 1;
|
---|
5825 | }
|
---|
5826 | else if (strcmp (name, "<") == 0)
|
---|
5827 | {
|
---|
5828 | cmpltr = 2;
|
---|
5829 | }
|
---|
5830 | else if (strcmp (name, "<=") == 0)
|
---|
5831 | {
|
---|
5832 | cmpltr = 3;
|
---|
5833 | }
|
---|
5834 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "nuv") == 0)
|
---|
5835 | {
|
---|
5836 | cmpltr = 4;
|
---|
5837 | }
|
---|
5838 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*=") == 0)
|
---|
5839 | {
|
---|
5840 | cmpltr = 5;
|
---|
5841 | }
|
---|
5842 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*<") == 0)
|
---|
5843 | {
|
---|
5844 | cmpltr = 6;
|
---|
5845 | }
|
---|
5846 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*<=") == 0)
|
---|
5847 | {
|
---|
5848 | cmpltr = 7;
|
---|
5849 | }
|
---|
5850 | else if (strcmp (name, "tr") == 0)
|
---|
5851 | {
|
---|
5852 | cmpltr = 8;
|
---|
5853 | }
|
---|
5854 | else if (strcmp (name, "<>") == 0)
|
---|
5855 | {
|
---|
5856 | cmpltr = 9;
|
---|
5857 | }
|
---|
5858 | else if (strcmp (name, ">=") == 0)
|
---|
5859 | {
|
---|
5860 | cmpltr = 10;
|
---|
5861 | }
|
---|
5862 | else if (strcmp (name, ">") == 0)
|
---|
5863 | {
|
---|
5864 | cmpltr = 11;
|
---|
5865 | }
|
---|
5866 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "uv") == 0)
|
---|
5867 | {
|
---|
5868 | cmpltr = 12;
|
---|
5869 | }
|
---|
5870 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*<>") == 0)
|
---|
5871 | {
|
---|
5872 | cmpltr = 13;
|
---|
5873 | }
|
---|
5874 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*>=") == 0)
|
---|
5875 | {
|
---|
5876 | cmpltr = 14;
|
---|
5877 | }
|
---|
5878 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "*>") == 0)
|
---|
5879 | {
|
---|
5880 | cmpltr = 15;
|
---|
5881 | }
|
---|
5882 | /* If we have something like addb,n then there is no condition
|
---|
5883 | completer. */
|
---|
5884 | else if (strcasecmp (name, "n") == 0)
|
---|
5885 | {
|
---|
5886 | cmpltr = 0;
|
---|
5887 | nullify = 1;
|
---|
5888 | }
|
---|
5889 | else
|
---|
5890 | {
|
---|
5891 | cmpltr = -1;
|
---|
5892 | }
|
---|
5893 | **s = c;
|
---|
5894 | }
|
---|
5895 |
|
---|
5896 | /* Reset pointers if this was really a ,n for a branch instruction. */
|
---|
5897 | if (nullify)
|
---|
5898 | *s = save_s;
|
---|
5899 |
|
---|
5900 | return cmpltr;
|
---|
5901 | }
|
---|
5902 |
|
---|
5903 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
5904 | /* Handle an alignment directive. Special so that we can update the
|
---|
5905 | alignment of the subspace if necessary. */
|
---|
5906 | static void
|
---|
5907 | pa_align (bytes)
|
---|
5908 | int bytes;
|
---|
5909 | {
|
---|
5910 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
5911 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
5912 |
|
---|
5913 | /* Let the generic gas code do most of the work. */
|
---|
5914 | s_align_bytes (bytes);
|
---|
5915 |
|
---|
5916 | /* If bytes is a power of 2, then update the current subspace's
|
---|
5917 | alignment if necessary. */
|
---|
5918 | if (log2 (bytes) != -1)
|
---|
5919 | record_alignment (current_subspace->ssd_seg, log2 (bytes));
|
---|
5920 | }
|
---|
5921 | #endif
|
---|
5922 |
|
---|
5923 | /* Handle a .BLOCK type pseudo-op. */
|
---|
5924 |
|
---|
5925 | static void
|
---|
5926 | pa_block (z)
|
---|
5927 | int z ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
5928 | {
|
---|
5929 | char *p;
|
---|
5930 | long int temp_fill;
|
---|
5931 | unsigned int temp_size;
|
---|
5932 | unsigned int i;
|
---|
5933 |
|
---|
5934 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
5935 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
5936 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
5937 | #endif
|
---|
5938 |
|
---|
5939 | temp_size = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
5940 |
|
---|
5941 | /* Always fill with zeros, that's what the HP assembler does. */
|
---|
5942 | temp_fill = 0;
|
---|
5943 |
|
---|
5944 | p = frag_var (rs_fill, (int) temp_size, (int) temp_size,
|
---|
5945 | (relax_substateT) 0, (symbolS *) 0, (offsetT) 1, NULL);
|
---|
5946 | memset (p, 0, temp_size);
|
---|
5947 |
|
---|
5948 | /* Convert 2 bytes at a time. */
|
---|
5949 |
|
---|
5950 | for (i = 0; i < temp_size; i += 2)
|
---|
5951 | {
|
---|
5952 | md_number_to_chars (p + i,
|
---|
5953 | (valueT) temp_fill,
|
---|
5954 | (int) ((temp_size - i) > 2 ? 2 : (temp_size - i)));
|
---|
5955 | }
|
---|
5956 |
|
---|
5957 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
5958 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
5959 | }
|
---|
5960 |
|
---|
5961 | /* Handle a .begin_brtab and .end_brtab pseudo-op. */
|
---|
5962 |
|
---|
5963 | static void
|
---|
5964 | pa_brtab (begin)
|
---|
5965 | int begin ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
5966 | {
|
---|
5967 |
|
---|
5968 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
5969 | /* The BRTAB relocations are only availble in SOM (to denote
|
---|
5970 | the beginning and end of branch tables). */
|
---|
5971 | char *where = frag_more (0);
|
---|
5972 |
|
---|
5973 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, where - frag_now->fr_literal, 0,
|
---|
5974 | NULL, (offsetT) 0, NULL,
|
---|
5975 | 0, begin ? R_HPPA_BEGIN_BRTAB : R_HPPA_END_BRTAB,
|
---|
5976 | e_fsel, 0, 0, 0);
|
---|
5977 | #endif
|
---|
5978 |
|
---|
5979 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
5980 | }
|
---|
5981 |
|
---|
5982 | /* Handle a .begin_try and .end_try pseudo-op. */
|
---|
5983 |
|
---|
5984 | static void
|
---|
5985 | pa_try (begin)
|
---|
5986 | int begin ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
5987 | {
|
---|
5988 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
5989 | expressionS exp;
|
---|
5990 | char *where = frag_more (0);
|
---|
5991 |
|
---|
5992 | if (! begin)
|
---|
5993 | expression (&exp);
|
---|
5994 |
|
---|
5995 | /* The TRY relocations are only availble in SOM (to denote
|
---|
5996 | the beginning and end of exception handling regions). */
|
---|
5997 |
|
---|
5998 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, where - frag_now->fr_literal, 0,
|
---|
5999 | NULL, (offsetT) 0, begin ? NULL : &exp,
|
---|
6000 | 0, begin ? R_HPPA_BEGIN_TRY : R_HPPA_END_TRY,
|
---|
6001 | e_fsel, 0, 0, 0);
|
---|
6002 | #endif
|
---|
6003 |
|
---|
6004 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6005 | }
|
---|
6006 |
|
---|
6007 | /* Handle a .CALL pseudo-op. This involves storing away information
|
---|
6008 | about where arguments are to be found so the linker can detect
|
---|
6009 | (and correct) argument location mismatches between caller and callee. */
|
---|
6010 |
|
---|
6011 | static void
|
---|
6012 | pa_call (unused)
|
---|
6013 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6014 | {
|
---|
6015 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6016 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
6017 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
6018 | #endif
|
---|
6019 |
|
---|
6020 | pa_call_args (&last_call_desc);
|
---|
6021 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6022 | }
|
---|
6023 |
|
---|
6024 | /* Do the dirty work of building a call descriptor which describes
|
---|
6025 | where the caller placed arguments to a function call. */
|
---|
6026 |
|
---|
6027 | static void
|
---|
6028 | pa_call_args (call_desc)
|
---|
6029 | struct call_desc *call_desc;
|
---|
6030 | {
|
---|
6031 | char *name, c, *p;
|
---|
6032 | unsigned int temp, arg_reloc;
|
---|
6033 |
|
---|
6034 | while (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6035 | {
|
---|
6036 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6037 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6038 | /* Process a source argument. */
|
---|
6039 | if ((strncasecmp (name, "argw", 4) == 0))
|
---|
6040 | {
|
---|
6041 | temp = atoi (name + 4);
|
---|
6042 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6043 | *p = c;
|
---|
6044 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6045 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6046 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6047 | arg_reloc = pa_build_arg_reloc (name);
|
---|
6048 | call_desc->arg_reloc |= pa_align_arg_reloc (temp, arg_reloc);
|
---|
6049 | }
|
---|
6050 | /* Process a return value. */
|
---|
6051 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "rtnval", 6) == 0))
|
---|
6052 | {
|
---|
6053 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6054 | *p = c;
|
---|
6055 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6056 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6057 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6058 | arg_reloc = pa_build_arg_reloc (name);
|
---|
6059 | call_desc->arg_reloc |= (arg_reloc & 0x3);
|
---|
6060 | }
|
---|
6061 | else
|
---|
6062 | {
|
---|
6063 | as_bad (_("Invalid .CALL argument: %s"), name);
|
---|
6064 | }
|
---|
6065 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6066 | *p = c;
|
---|
6067 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6068 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6069 | }
|
---|
6070 | }
|
---|
6071 |
|
---|
6072 | /* Return TRUE if FRAG1 and FRAG2 are the same. */
|
---|
6073 |
|
---|
6074 | static int
|
---|
6075 | is_same_frag (frag1, frag2)
|
---|
6076 | fragS *frag1;
|
---|
6077 | fragS *frag2;
|
---|
6078 | {
|
---|
6079 |
|
---|
6080 | if (frag1 == NULL)
|
---|
6081 | return (FALSE);
|
---|
6082 | else if (frag2 == NULL)
|
---|
6083 | return (FALSE);
|
---|
6084 | else if (frag1 == frag2)
|
---|
6085 | return (TRUE);
|
---|
6086 | else if (frag2->fr_type == rs_fill && frag2->fr_fix == 0)
|
---|
6087 | return (is_same_frag (frag1, frag2->fr_next));
|
---|
6088 | else
|
---|
6089 | return (FALSE);
|
---|
6090 | }
|
---|
6091 |
|
---|
6092 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
6093 | /* Build an entry in the UNWIND subspace from the given function
|
---|
6094 | attributes in CALL_INFO. This is not needed for SOM as using
|
---|
6095 | R_ENTRY and R_EXIT relocations allow the linker to handle building
|
---|
6096 | of the unwind spaces. */
|
---|
6097 |
|
---|
6098 | static void
|
---|
6099 | pa_build_unwind_subspace (call_info)
|
---|
6100 | struct call_info *call_info;
|
---|
6101 | {
|
---|
6102 | asection *seg, *save_seg;
|
---|
6103 | subsegT save_subseg;
|
---|
6104 | unsigned int unwind;
|
---|
6105 | int reloc;
|
---|
6106 | char *p;
|
---|
6107 |
|
---|
6108 | if ((bfd_get_section_flags (stdoutput, now_seg)
|
---|
6109 | & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
|
---|
6110 | != (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
|
---|
6111 | return;
|
---|
6112 |
|
---|
6113 | reloc = R_PARISC_SEGREL32;
|
---|
6114 | save_seg = now_seg;
|
---|
6115 | save_subseg = now_subseg;
|
---|
6116 | /* Get into the right seg/subseg. This may involve creating
|
---|
6117 | the seg the first time through. Make sure to have the
|
---|
6118 | old seg/subseg so that we can reset things when we are done. */
|
---|
6119 | seg = bfd_get_section_by_name (stdoutput, UNWIND_SECTION_NAME);
|
---|
6120 | if (seg == ASEC_NULL)
|
---|
6121 | {
|
---|
6122 | seg = subseg_new (UNWIND_SECTION_NAME, 0);
|
---|
6123 | bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, seg,
|
---|
6124 | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
|
---|
6125 | | SEC_LOAD | SEC_RELOC | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_DATA);
|
---|
6126 | bfd_set_section_alignment (stdoutput, seg, 2);
|
---|
6127 | }
|
---|
6128 |
|
---|
6129 | subseg_set (seg, 0);
|
---|
6130 |
|
---|
6131 | /* Get some space to hold relocation information for the unwind
|
---|
6132 | descriptor. */
|
---|
6133 | p = frag_more (16);
|
---|
6134 |
|
---|
6135 | /* Relocation info. for start offset of the function. */
|
---|
6136 | md_number_to_chars (p, 0, 4);
|
---|
6137 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, p - frag_now->fr_literal, 4,
|
---|
6138 | call_info->start_symbol, (offsetT) 0,
|
---|
6139 | (expressionS *) NULL, 0, reloc,
|
---|
6140 | e_fsel, 32, 0, 0);
|
---|
6141 |
|
---|
6142 | /* Relocation info. for end offset of the function.
|
---|
6143 |
|
---|
6144 | Because we allow reductions of 32bit relocations for ELF, this will be
|
---|
6145 | reduced to section_sym + offset which avoids putting the temporary
|
---|
6146 | symbol into the symbol table. It (should) end up giving the same
|
---|
6147 | value as call_info->start_symbol + function size once the linker is
|
---|
6148 | finished with its work. */
|
---|
6149 | md_number_to_chars (p + 4, 0, 4);
|
---|
6150 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, p + 4 - frag_now->fr_literal, 4,
|
---|
6151 | call_info->end_symbol, (offsetT) 0,
|
---|
6152 | (expressionS *) NULL, 0, reloc,
|
---|
6153 | e_fsel, 32, 0, 0);
|
---|
6154 |
|
---|
6155 | /* Dump the descriptor. */
|
---|
6156 | unwind = UNWIND_LOW32 (&call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor);
|
---|
6157 | md_number_to_chars (p + 8, unwind, 4);
|
---|
6158 |
|
---|
6159 | unwind = UNWIND_HIGH32 (&call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor);
|
---|
6160 | md_number_to_chars (p + 12, unwind, 4);
|
---|
6161 |
|
---|
6162 | /* Return back to the original segment/subsegment. */
|
---|
6163 | subseg_set (save_seg, save_subseg);
|
---|
6164 | }
|
---|
6165 | #endif
|
---|
6166 |
|
---|
6167 | /* Process a .CALLINFO pseudo-op. This information is used later
|
---|
6168 | to build unwind descriptors and maybe one day to support
|
---|
6169 | .ENTER and .LEAVE. */
|
---|
6170 |
|
---|
6171 | static void
|
---|
6172 | pa_callinfo (unused)
|
---|
6173 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6174 | {
|
---|
6175 | char *name, c, *p;
|
---|
6176 | int temp;
|
---|
6177 |
|
---|
6178 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6179 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
6180 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
6181 | #endif
|
---|
6182 |
|
---|
6183 | /* .CALLINFO must appear within a procedure definition. */
|
---|
6184 | if (!within_procedure)
|
---|
6185 | as_bad (_(".callinfo is not within a procedure definition"));
|
---|
6186 |
|
---|
6187 | /* Mark the fact that we found the .CALLINFO for the
|
---|
6188 | current procedure. */
|
---|
6189 | callinfo_found = TRUE;
|
---|
6190 |
|
---|
6191 | /* Iterate over the .CALLINFO arguments. */
|
---|
6192 | while (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6193 | {
|
---|
6194 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6195 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6196 | /* Frame size specification. */
|
---|
6197 | if ((strncasecmp (name, "frame", 5) == 0))
|
---|
6198 | {
|
---|
6199 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6200 | *p = c;
|
---|
6201 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6202 | temp = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
6203 | if ((temp & 0x3) != 0)
|
---|
6204 | {
|
---|
6205 | as_bad (_("FRAME parameter must be a multiple of 8: %d\n"), temp);
|
---|
6206 | temp = 0;
|
---|
6207 | }
|
---|
6208 |
|
---|
6209 | /* callinfo is in bytes and unwind_desc is in 8 byte units. */
|
---|
6210 | last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.frame_size = temp / 8;
|
---|
6211 |
|
---|
6212 | }
|
---|
6213 | /* Entry register (GR, GR and SR) specifications. */
|
---|
6214 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "entry_gr", 8) == 0))
|
---|
6215 | {
|
---|
6216 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6217 | *p = c;
|
---|
6218 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6219 | temp = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
6220 | /* The HP assembler accepts 19 as the high bound for ENTRY_GR
|
---|
6221 | even though %r19 is caller saved. I think this is a bug in
|
---|
6222 | the HP assembler, and we are not going to emulate it. */
|
---|
6223 | if (temp < 3 || temp > 18)
|
---|
6224 | as_bad (_("Value for ENTRY_GR must be in the range 3..18\n"));
|
---|
6225 | last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.entry_gr = temp - 2;
|
---|
6226 | }
|
---|
6227 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "entry_fr", 8) == 0))
|
---|
6228 | {
|
---|
6229 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6230 | *p = c;
|
---|
6231 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6232 | temp = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
6233 | /* Similarly the HP assembler takes 31 as the high bound even
|
---|
6234 | though %fr21 is the last callee saved floating point register. */
|
---|
6235 | if (temp < 12 || temp > 21)
|
---|
6236 | as_bad (_("Value for ENTRY_FR must be in the range 12..21\n"));
|
---|
6237 | last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.entry_fr = temp - 11;
|
---|
6238 | }
|
---|
6239 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "entry_sr", 8) == 0))
|
---|
6240 | {
|
---|
6241 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6242 | *p = c;
|
---|
6243 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6244 | temp = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
6245 | if (temp != 3)
|
---|
6246 | as_bad (_("Value for ENTRY_SR must be 3\n"));
|
---|
6247 | }
|
---|
6248 | /* Note whether or not this function performs any calls. */
|
---|
6249 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "calls", 5) == 0) ||
|
---|
6250 | (strncasecmp (name, "caller", 6) == 0))
|
---|
6251 | {
|
---|
6252 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6253 | *p = c;
|
---|
6254 | }
|
---|
6255 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "no_calls", 8) == 0))
|
---|
6256 | {
|
---|
6257 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6258 | *p = c;
|
---|
6259 | }
|
---|
6260 | /* Should RP be saved into the stack. */
|
---|
6261 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "save_rp", 7) == 0))
|
---|
6262 | {
|
---|
6263 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6264 | *p = c;
|
---|
6265 | last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.save_rp = 1;
|
---|
6266 | }
|
---|
6267 | /* Likewise for SP. */
|
---|
6268 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "save_sp", 7) == 0))
|
---|
6269 | {
|
---|
6270 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6271 | *p = c;
|
---|
6272 | last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.save_sp = 1;
|
---|
6273 | }
|
---|
6274 | /* Is this an unwindable procedure. If so mark it so
|
---|
6275 | in the unwind descriptor. */
|
---|
6276 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "no_unwind", 9) == 0))
|
---|
6277 | {
|
---|
6278 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6279 | *p = c;
|
---|
6280 | last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.cannot_unwind = 1;
|
---|
6281 | }
|
---|
6282 | /* Is this an interrupt routine. If so mark it in the
|
---|
6283 | unwind descriptor. */
|
---|
6284 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "hpux_int", 7) == 0))
|
---|
6285 | {
|
---|
6286 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6287 | *p = c;
|
---|
6288 | last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.hpux_interrupt_marker = 1;
|
---|
6289 | }
|
---|
6290 | /* Is this a millicode routine. "millicode" isn't in my
|
---|
6291 | assembler manual, but my copy is old. The HP assembler
|
---|
6292 | accepts it, and there's a place in the unwind descriptor
|
---|
6293 | to drop the information, so we'll accept it too. */
|
---|
6294 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "millicode", 9) == 0))
|
---|
6295 | {
|
---|
6296 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6297 | *p = c;
|
---|
6298 | last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.millicode = 1;
|
---|
6299 | }
|
---|
6300 | else
|
---|
6301 | {
|
---|
6302 | as_bad (_("Invalid .CALLINFO argument: %s"), name);
|
---|
6303 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
6304 | }
|
---|
6305 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6306 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6307 | }
|
---|
6308 |
|
---|
6309 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6310 | }
|
---|
6311 |
|
---|
6312 | #if !(defined (OBJ_ELF) && defined (TE_LINUX))
|
---|
6313 | /* Switch to the text space. Like s_text, but delete our
|
---|
6314 | label when finished. */
|
---|
6315 | static void
|
---|
6316 | pa_text (unused)
|
---|
6317 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6318 | {
|
---|
6319 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6320 | current_space = is_defined_space ("$TEXT$");
|
---|
6321 | current_subspace
|
---|
6322 | = pa_subsegment_to_subspace (current_space->sd_seg, 0);
|
---|
6323 | #endif
|
---|
6324 |
|
---|
6325 | s_text (0);
|
---|
6326 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
6327 | }
|
---|
6328 |
|
---|
6329 | /* Switch to the data space. As usual delete our label. */
|
---|
6330 | static void
|
---|
6331 | pa_data (unused)
|
---|
6332 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6333 | {
|
---|
6334 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6335 | current_space = is_defined_space ("$PRIVATE$");
|
---|
6336 | current_subspace
|
---|
6337 | = pa_subsegment_to_subspace (current_space->sd_seg, 0);
|
---|
6338 | #endif
|
---|
6339 | s_data (0);
|
---|
6340 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
6341 | }
|
---|
6342 |
|
---|
6343 | /* This is different than the standard GAS s_comm(). On HP9000/800 machines,
|
---|
6344 | the .comm pseudo-op has the following symtax:
|
---|
6345 |
|
---|
6346 | <label> .comm <length>
|
---|
6347 |
|
---|
6348 | where <label> is optional and is a symbol whose address will be the start of
|
---|
6349 | a block of memory <length> bytes long. <length> must be an absolute
|
---|
6350 | expression. <length> bytes will be allocated in the current space
|
---|
6351 | and subspace.
|
---|
6352 |
|
---|
6353 | Also note the label may not even be on the same line as the .comm.
|
---|
6354 |
|
---|
6355 | This difference in syntax means the colon function will be called
|
---|
6356 | on the symbol before we arrive in pa_comm. colon will set a number
|
---|
6357 | of attributes of the symbol that need to be fixed here. In particular
|
---|
6358 | the value, section pointer, fragment pointer, flags, etc. What
|
---|
6359 | a pain.
|
---|
6360 |
|
---|
6361 | This also makes error detection all but impossible. */
|
---|
6362 |
|
---|
6363 | static void
|
---|
6364 | pa_comm (unused)
|
---|
6365 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6366 | {
|
---|
6367 | unsigned int size;
|
---|
6368 | symbolS *symbol;
|
---|
6369 | label_symbol_struct *label_symbol = pa_get_label ();
|
---|
6370 |
|
---|
6371 | if (label_symbol)
|
---|
6372 | symbol = label_symbol->lss_label;
|
---|
6373 | else
|
---|
6374 | symbol = NULL;
|
---|
6375 |
|
---|
6376 | SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
|
---|
6377 | size = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
6378 |
|
---|
6379 | if (symbol)
|
---|
6380 | {
|
---|
6381 | S_SET_VALUE (symbol, size);
|
---|
6382 | S_SET_SEGMENT (symbol, bfd_und_section_ptr);
|
---|
6383 | S_SET_EXTERNAL (symbol);
|
---|
6384 |
|
---|
6385 | /* colon() has already set the frag to the current location in the
|
---|
6386 | current subspace; we need to reset the fragment to the zero address
|
---|
6387 | fragment. We also need to reset the segment pointer. */
|
---|
6388 | symbol_set_frag (symbol, &zero_address_frag);
|
---|
6389 | }
|
---|
6390 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6391 | }
|
---|
6392 | #endif /* !(defined (OBJ_ELF) && defined (TE_LINUX)) */
|
---|
6393 |
|
---|
6394 | /* Process a .END pseudo-op. */
|
---|
6395 |
|
---|
6396 | static void
|
---|
6397 | pa_end (unused)
|
---|
6398 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6399 | {
|
---|
6400 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6401 | }
|
---|
6402 |
|
---|
6403 | /* Process a .ENTER pseudo-op. This is not supported. */
|
---|
6404 | static void
|
---|
6405 | pa_enter (unused)
|
---|
6406 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6407 | {
|
---|
6408 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6409 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
6410 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
6411 | #endif
|
---|
6412 |
|
---|
6413 | as_bad (_("The .ENTER pseudo-op is not supported"));
|
---|
6414 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6415 | }
|
---|
6416 |
|
---|
6417 | /* Process a .ENTRY pseudo-op. .ENTRY marks the beginning of the
|
---|
6418 | procesure. */
|
---|
6419 | static void
|
---|
6420 | pa_entry (unused)
|
---|
6421 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6422 | {
|
---|
6423 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6424 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
6425 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
6426 | #endif
|
---|
6427 |
|
---|
6428 | if (!within_procedure)
|
---|
6429 | as_bad (_("Misplaced .entry. Ignored."));
|
---|
6430 | else
|
---|
6431 | {
|
---|
6432 | if (!callinfo_found)
|
---|
6433 | as_bad (_("Missing .callinfo."));
|
---|
6434 | }
|
---|
6435 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6436 | within_entry_exit = TRUE;
|
---|
6437 |
|
---|
6438 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6439 | /* SOM defers building of unwind descriptors until the link phase.
|
---|
6440 | The assembler is responsible for creating an R_ENTRY relocation
|
---|
6441 | to mark the beginning of a region and hold the unwind bits, and
|
---|
6442 | for creating an R_EXIT relocation to mark the end of the region.
|
---|
6443 |
|
---|
6444 | FIXME. ELF should be using the same conventions! The problem
|
---|
6445 | is an unwind requires too much relocation space. Hmmm. Maybe
|
---|
6446 | if we split the unwind bits up between the relocations which
|
---|
6447 | denote the entry and exit points. */
|
---|
6448 | if (last_call_info->start_symbol != NULL)
|
---|
6449 | {
|
---|
6450 | char *where;
|
---|
6451 | unsigned int u;
|
---|
6452 |
|
---|
6453 | where = frag_more (0);
|
---|
6454 | u = UNWIND_LOW32 (&last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor);
|
---|
6455 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, where - frag_now->fr_literal, 0,
|
---|
6456 | NULL, (offsetT) 0, NULL,
|
---|
6457 | 0, R_HPPA_ENTRY, e_fsel, 0, 0, u);
|
---|
6458 | }
|
---|
6459 | #endif
|
---|
6460 | }
|
---|
6461 |
|
---|
6462 | /* Silly nonsense for pa_equ. The only half-sensible use for this is
|
---|
6463 | being able to subtract two register symbols that specify a range of
|
---|
6464 | registers, to get the size of the range. */
|
---|
6465 | static int fudge_reg_expressions;
|
---|
6466 |
|
---|
6467 | int
|
---|
6468 | hppa_force_reg_syms_absolute (resultP, op, rightP)
|
---|
6469 | expressionS *resultP;
|
---|
6470 | operatorT op ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6471 | expressionS *rightP;
|
---|
6472 | {
|
---|
6473 | if (fudge_reg_expressions
|
---|
6474 | && rightP->X_op == O_register
|
---|
6475 | && resultP->X_op == O_register)
|
---|
6476 | {
|
---|
6477 | rightP->X_op = O_constant;
|
---|
6478 | resultP->X_op = O_constant;
|
---|
6479 | }
|
---|
6480 | return 0; /* Continue normal expr handling. */
|
---|
6481 | }
|
---|
6482 |
|
---|
6483 | /* Handle a .EQU pseudo-op. */
|
---|
6484 |
|
---|
6485 | static void
|
---|
6486 | pa_equ (reg)
|
---|
6487 | int reg;
|
---|
6488 | {
|
---|
6489 | label_symbol_struct *label_symbol = pa_get_label ();
|
---|
6490 | symbolS *symbol;
|
---|
6491 |
|
---|
6492 | if (label_symbol)
|
---|
6493 | {
|
---|
6494 | symbol = label_symbol->lss_label;
|
---|
6495 | if (reg)
|
---|
6496 | {
|
---|
6497 | strict = 1;
|
---|
6498 | if (!pa_parse_number (&input_line_pointer, 0))
|
---|
6499 | as_bad (_(".REG expression must be a register"));
|
---|
6500 | S_SET_VALUE (symbol, pa_number);
|
---|
6501 | S_SET_SEGMENT (symbol, reg_section);
|
---|
6502 | }
|
---|
6503 | else
|
---|
6504 | {
|
---|
6505 | expressionS exp;
|
---|
6506 | segT seg;
|
---|
6507 |
|
---|
6508 | fudge_reg_expressions = 1;
|
---|
6509 | seg = expression (&exp);
|
---|
6510 | fudge_reg_expressions = 0;
|
---|
6511 | if (exp.X_op != O_constant
|
---|
6512 | && exp.X_op != O_register)
|
---|
6513 | {
|
---|
6514 | if (exp.X_op != O_absent)
|
---|
6515 | as_bad (_("bad or irreducible absolute expression; zero assumed"));
|
---|
6516 | exp.X_add_number = 0;
|
---|
6517 | seg = absolute_section;
|
---|
6518 | }
|
---|
6519 | S_SET_VALUE (symbol, (unsigned int) exp.X_add_number);
|
---|
6520 | S_SET_SEGMENT (symbol, seg);
|
---|
6521 | }
|
---|
6522 | }
|
---|
6523 | else
|
---|
6524 | {
|
---|
6525 | if (reg)
|
---|
6526 | as_bad (_(".REG must use a label"));
|
---|
6527 | else
|
---|
6528 | as_bad (_(".EQU must use a label"));
|
---|
6529 | }
|
---|
6530 |
|
---|
6531 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
6532 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6533 | }
|
---|
6534 |
|
---|
6535 | /* Helper function. Does processing for the end of a function. This
|
---|
6536 | usually involves creating some relocations or building special
|
---|
6537 | symbols to mark the end of the function. */
|
---|
6538 |
|
---|
6539 | static void
|
---|
6540 | process_exit ()
|
---|
6541 | {
|
---|
6542 | char *where;
|
---|
6543 |
|
---|
6544 | where = frag_more (0);
|
---|
6545 |
|
---|
6546 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
6547 | /* Mark the end of the function, stuff away the location of the frag
|
---|
6548 | for the end of the function, and finally call pa_build_unwind_subspace
|
---|
6549 | to add an entry in the unwind table. */
|
---|
6550 | hppa_elf_mark_end_of_function ();
|
---|
6551 | pa_build_unwind_subspace (last_call_info);
|
---|
6552 | #else
|
---|
6553 | /* SOM defers building of unwind descriptors until the link phase.
|
---|
6554 | The assembler is responsible for creating an R_ENTRY relocation
|
---|
6555 | to mark the beginning of a region and hold the unwind bits, and
|
---|
6556 | for creating an R_EXIT relocation to mark the end of the region.
|
---|
6557 |
|
---|
6558 | FIXME. ELF should be using the same conventions! The problem
|
---|
6559 | is an unwind requires too much relocation space. Hmmm. Maybe
|
---|
6560 | if we split the unwind bits up between the relocations which
|
---|
6561 | denote the entry and exit points. */
|
---|
6562 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, where - frag_now->fr_literal, 0,
|
---|
6563 | NULL, (offsetT) 0,
|
---|
6564 | NULL, 0, R_HPPA_EXIT, e_fsel, 0, 0,
|
---|
6565 | UNWIND_HIGH32 (&last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor));
|
---|
6566 | #endif
|
---|
6567 | }
|
---|
6568 |
|
---|
6569 | /* Process a .EXIT pseudo-op. */
|
---|
6570 |
|
---|
6571 | static void
|
---|
6572 | pa_exit (unused)
|
---|
6573 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6574 | {
|
---|
6575 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6576 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
6577 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
6578 | #endif
|
---|
6579 |
|
---|
6580 | if (!within_procedure)
|
---|
6581 | as_bad (_(".EXIT must appear within a procedure"));
|
---|
6582 | else
|
---|
6583 | {
|
---|
6584 | if (!callinfo_found)
|
---|
6585 | as_bad (_("Missing .callinfo"));
|
---|
6586 | else
|
---|
6587 | {
|
---|
6588 | if (!within_entry_exit)
|
---|
6589 | as_bad (_("No .ENTRY for this .EXIT"));
|
---|
6590 | else
|
---|
6591 | {
|
---|
6592 | within_entry_exit = FALSE;
|
---|
6593 | process_exit ();
|
---|
6594 | }
|
---|
6595 | }
|
---|
6596 | }
|
---|
6597 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6598 | }
|
---|
6599 |
|
---|
6600 | /* Process a .EXPORT directive. This makes functions external
|
---|
6601 | and provides information such as argument relocation entries
|
---|
6602 | to callers. */
|
---|
6603 |
|
---|
6604 | static void
|
---|
6605 | pa_export (unused)
|
---|
6606 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6607 | {
|
---|
6608 | char *name, c, *p;
|
---|
6609 | symbolS *symbol;
|
---|
6610 |
|
---|
6611 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6612 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6613 | /* Make sure the given symbol exists. */
|
---|
6614 | if ((symbol = symbol_find_or_make (name)) == NULL)
|
---|
6615 | {
|
---|
6616 | as_bad (_("Cannot define export symbol: %s\n"), name);
|
---|
6617 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6618 | *p = c;
|
---|
6619 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6620 | }
|
---|
6621 | else
|
---|
6622 | {
|
---|
6623 | /* OK. Set the external bits and process argument relocations.
|
---|
6624 | For the HP, weak and global are not mutually exclusive.
|
---|
6625 | S_SET_EXTERNAL will not set BSF_GLOBAL if WEAK is set.
|
---|
6626 | Call S_SET_EXTERNAL to get the other processing. Manually
|
---|
6627 | set BSF_GLOBAL when we get back. */
|
---|
6628 | S_SET_EXTERNAL (symbol);
|
---|
6629 | symbol_get_bfdsym (symbol)->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
|
---|
6630 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6631 | *p = c;
|
---|
6632 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6633 | {
|
---|
6634 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6635 | pa_type_args (symbol, 1);
|
---|
6636 | }
|
---|
6637 | }
|
---|
6638 |
|
---|
6639 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6640 | }
|
---|
6641 |
|
---|
6642 | /* Helper function to process arguments to a .EXPORT pseudo-op. */
|
---|
6643 |
|
---|
6644 | static void
|
---|
6645 | pa_type_args (symbolP, is_export)
|
---|
6646 | symbolS *symbolP;
|
---|
6647 | int is_export;
|
---|
6648 | {
|
---|
6649 | char *name, c, *p;
|
---|
6650 | unsigned int temp, arg_reloc;
|
---|
6651 | pa_symbol_type type = SYMBOL_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
|
---|
6652 | asymbol *bfdsym = symbol_get_bfdsym (symbolP);
|
---|
6653 |
|
---|
6654 | if (strncasecmp (input_line_pointer, "absolute", 8) == 0)
|
---|
6655 |
|
---|
6656 | {
|
---|
6657 | input_line_pointer += 8;
|
---|
6658 | bfdsym->flags &= ~BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6659 | S_SET_SEGMENT (symbolP, bfd_abs_section_ptr);
|
---|
6660 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_ABSOLUTE;
|
---|
6661 | }
|
---|
6662 | else if (strncasecmp (input_line_pointer, "code", 4) == 0)
|
---|
6663 | {
|
---|
6664 | input_line_pointer += 4;
|
---|
6665 | /* IMPORTing/EXPORTing CODE types for functions is meaningless for SOM,
|
---|
6666 | instead one should be IMPORTing/EXPORTing ENTRY types.
|
---|
6667 |
|
---|
6668 | Complain if one tries to EXPORT a CODE type since that's never
|
---|
6669 | done. Both GCC and HP C still try to IMPORT CODE types, so
|
---|
6670 | silently fix them to be ENTRY types. */
|
---|
6671 | if (S_IS_FUNCTION (symbolP))
|
---|
6672 | {
|
---|
6673 | if (is_export)
|
---|
6674 | as_tsktsk (_("Using ENTRY rather than CODE in export directive for %s"),
|
---|
6675 | S_GET_NAME (symbolP));
|
---|
6676 |
|
---|
6677 | bfdsym->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6678 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_ENTRY;
|
---|
6679 | }
|
---|
6680 | else
|
---|
6681 | {
|
---|
6682 | bfdsym->flags &= ~BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6683 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_CODE;
|
---|
6684 | }
|
---|
6685 | }
|
---|
6686 | else if (strncasecmp (input_line_pointer, "data", 4) == 0)
|
---|
6687 | {
|
---|
6688 | input_line_pointer += 4;
|
---|
6689 | bfdsym->flags &= ~BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6690 | bfdsym->flags |= BSF_OBJECT;
|
---|
6691 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_DATA;
|
---|
6692 | }
|
---|
6693 | else if ((strncasecmp (input_line_pointer, "entry", 5) == 0))
|
---|
6694 | {
|
---|
6695 | input_line_pointer += 5;
|
---|
6696 | bfdsym->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6697 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_ENTRY;
|
---|
6698 | }
|
---|
6699 | else if (strncasecmp (input_line_pointer, "millicode", 9) == 0)
|
---|
6700 | {
|
---|
6701 | input_line_pointer += 9;
|
---|
6702 | bfdsym->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6703 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
6704 | {
|
---|
6705 | elf_symbol_type *elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfdsym;
|
---|
6706 | elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info =
|
---|
6707 | ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info),
|
---|
6708 | STT_PARISC_MILLI);
|
---|
6709 | }
|
---|
6710 | #endif
|
---|
6711 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_MILLICODE;
|
---|
6712 | }
|
---|
6713 | else if (strncasecmp (input_line_pointer, "plabel", 6) == 0)
|
---|
6714 | {
|
---|
6715 | input_line_pointer += 6;
|
---|
6716 | bfdsym->flags &= ~BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6717 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_PLABEL;
|
---|
6718 | }
|
---|
6719 | else if (strncasecmp (input_line_pointer, "pri_prog", 8) == 0)
|
---|
6720 | {
|
---|
6721 | input_line_pointer += 8;
|
---|
6722 | bfdsym->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6723 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_PRI_PROG;
|
---|
6724 | }
|
---|
6725 | else if (strncasecmp (input_line_pointer, "sec_prog", 8) == 0)
|
---|
6726 | {
|
---|
6727 | input_line_pointer += 8;
|
---|
6728 | bfdsym->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6729 | type = SYMBOL_TYPE_SEC_PROG;
|
---|
6730 | }
|
---|
6731 |
|
---|
6732 | /* SOM requires much more information about symbol types
|
---|
6733 | than BFD understands. This is how we get this information
|
---|
6734 | to the SOM BFD backend. */
|
---|
6735 | #ifdef obj_set_symbol_type
|
---|
6736 | obj_set_symbol_type (bfdsym, (int) type);
|
---|
6737 | #endif
|
---|
6738 |
|
---|
6739 | /* Now that the type of the exported symbol has been handled,
|
---|
6740 | handle any argument relocation information. */
|
---|
6741 | while (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6742 | {
|
---|
6743 | if (*input_line_pointer == ',')
|
---|
6744 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6745 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6746 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6747 | /* Argument sources. */
|
---|
6748 | if ((strncasecmp (name, "argw", 4) == 0))
|
---|
6749 | {
|
---|
6750 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6751 | *p = c;
|
---|
6752 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6753 | temp = atoi (name + 4);
|
---|
6754 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6755 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6756 | arg_reloc = pa_align_arg_reloc (temp, pa_build_arg_reloc (name));
|
---|
6757 | #if defined (OBJ_SOM) || defined (ELF_ARG_RELOC)
|
---|
6758 | symbol_arg_reloc_info (symbolP) |= arg_reloc;
|
---|
6759 | #endif
|
---|
6760 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
6761 | }
|
---|
6762 | /* The return value. */
|
---|
6763 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "rtnval", 6)) == 0)
|
---|
6764 | {
|
---|
6765 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6766 | *p = c;
|
---|
6767 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6768 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6769 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6770 | arg_reloc = pa_build_arg_reloc (name);
|
---|
6771 | #if defined (OBJ_SOM) || defined (ELF_ARG_RELOC)
|
---|
6772 | symbol_arg_reloc_info (symbolP) |= arg_reloc;
|
---|
6773 | #endif
|
---|
6774 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
6775 | }
|
---|
6776 | /* Privelege level. */
|
---|
6777 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "priv_lev", 8)) == 0)
|
---|
6778 | {
|
---|
6779 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6780 | *p = c;
|
---|
6781 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6782 | temp = atoi (input_line_pointer);
|
---|
6783 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6784 | ((obj_symbol_type *) bfdsym)->tc_data.ap.hppa_priv_level = temp;
|
---|
6785 | #endif
|
---|
6786 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6787 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
6788 | }
|
---|
6789 | else
|
---|
6790 | {
|
---|
6791 | as_bad (_("Undefined .EXPORT/.IMPORT argument (ignored): %s"), name);
|
---|
6792 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6793 | *p = c;
|
---|
6794 | }
|
---|
6795 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6796 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6797 | }
|
---|
6798 | }
|
---|
6799 |
|
---|
6800 | /* Handle an .IMPORT pseudo-op. Any symbol referenced in a given
|
---|
6801 | assembly file must either be defined in the assembly file, or
|
---|
6802 | explicitly IMPORTED from another. */
|
---|
6803 |
|
---|
6804 | static void
|
---|
6805 | pa_import (unused)
|
---|
6806 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6807 | {
|
---|
6808 | char *name, c, *p;
|
---|
6809 | symbolS *symbol;
|
---|
6810 |
|
---|
6811 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6812 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6813 |
|
---|
6814 | symbol = symbol_find (name);
|
---|
6815 | /* Ugh. We might be importing a symbol defined earlier in the file,
|
---|
6816 | in which case all the code below will really screw things up
|
---|
6817 | (set the wrong segment, symbol flags & type, etc). */
|
---|
6818 | if (symbol == NULL || !S_IS_DEFINED (symbol))
|
---|
6819 | {
|
---|
6820 | symbol = symbol_find_or_make (name);
|
---|
6821 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6822 | *p = c;
|
---|
6823 |
|
---|
6824 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6825 | {
|
---|
6826 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6827 | pa_type_args (symbol, 0);
|
---|
6828 | }
|
---|
6829 | else
|
---|
6830 | {
|
---|
6831 | /* Sigh. To be compatable with the HP assembler and to help
|
---|
6832 | poorly written assembly code, we assign a type based on
|
---|
6833 | the current segment. Note only BSF_FUNCTION really
|
---|
6834 | matters, we do not need to set the full SYMBOL_TYPE_* info. */
|
---|
6835 | if (now_seg == text_section)
|
---|
6836 | symbol_get_bfdsym (symbol)->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
6837 |
|
---|
6838 | /* If the section is undefined, then the symbol is undefined
|
---|
6839 | Since this is an import, leave the section undefined. */
|
---|
6840 | S_SET_SEGMENT (symbol, bfd_und_section_ptr);
|
---|
6841 | }
|
---|
6842 | }
|
---|
6843 | else
|
---|
6844 | {
|
---|
6845 | /* The symbol was already defined. Just eat everything up to
|
---|
6846 | the end of the current statement. */
|
---|
6847 | while (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6848 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6849 | }
|
---|
6850 |
|
---|
6851 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6852 | }
|
---|
6853 |
|
---|
6854 | /* Handle a .LABEL pseudo-op. */
|
---|
6855 |
|
---|
6856 | static void
|
---|
6857 | pa_label (unused)
|
---|
6858 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6859 | {
|
---|
6860 | char *name, c, *p;
|
---|
6861 |
|
---|
6862 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6863 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6864 |
|
---|
6865 | if (strlen (name) > 0)
|
---|
6866 | {
|
---|
6867 | colon (name);
|
---|
6868 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6869 | *p = c;
|
---|
6870 | }
|
---|
6871 | else
|
---|
6872 | {
|
---|
6873 | as_warn (_("Missing label name on .LABEL"));
|
---|
6874 | }
|
---|
6875 |
|
---|
6876 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6877 | {
|
---|
6878 | as_warn (_("extra .LABEL arguments ignored."));
|
---|
6879 | ignore_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6880 | }
|
---|
6881 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6882 | }
|
---|
6883 |
|
---|
6884 | /* Handle a .LEAVE pseudo-op. This is not supported yet. */
|
---|
6885 |
|
---|
6886 | static void
|
---|
6887 | pa_leave (unused)
|
---|
6888 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6889 | {
|
---|
6890 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6891 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
6892 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
6893 | #endif
|
---|
6894 |
|
---|
6895 | as_bad (_("The .LEAVE pseudo-op is not supported"));
|
---|
6896 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6897 | }
|
---|
6898 |
|
---|
6899 | /* Handle a .LEVEL pseudo-op. */
|
---|
6900 |
|
---|
6901 | static void
|
---|
6902 | pa_level (unused)
|
---|
6903 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6904 | {
|
---|
6905 | char *level;
|
---|
6906 |
|
---|
6907 | level = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6908 | if (strncmp (level, "1.0", 3) == 0)
|
---|
6909 | {
|
---|
6910 | input_line_pointer += 3;
|
---|
6911 | if (!bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_hppa, 10))
|
---|
6912 | as_warn (_("could not set architecture and machine"));
|
---|
6913 | }
|
---|
6914 | else if (strncmp (level, "1.1", 3) == 0)
|
---|
6915 | {
|
---|
6916 | input_line_pointer += 3;
|
---|
6917 | if (!bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_hppa, 11))
|
---|
6918 | as_warn (_("could not set architecture and machine"));
|
---|
6919 | }
|
---|
6920 | else if (strncmp (level, "2.0w", 4) == 0)
|
---|
6921 | {
|
---|
6922 | input_line_pointer += 4;
|
---|
6923 | if (!bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_hppa, 25))
|
---|
6924 | as_warn (_("could not set architecture and machine"));
|
---|
6925 | }
|
---|
6926 | else if (strncmp (level, "2.0", 3) == 0)
|
---|
6927 | {
|
---|
6928 | input_line_pointer += 3;
|
---|
6929 | if (!bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_hppa, 20))
|
---|
6930 | as_warn (_("could not set architecture and machine"));
|
---|
6931 | }
|
---|
6932 | else
|
---|
6933 | {
|
---|
6934 | as_bad (_("Unrecognized .LEVEL argument\n"));
|
---|
6935 | ignore_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6936 | }
|
---|
6937 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6938 | }
|
---|
6939 |
|
---|
6940 | /* Handle a .ORIGIN pseudo-op. */
|
---|
6941 |
|
---|
6942 | static void
|
---|
6943 | pa_origin (unused)
|
---|
6944 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6945 | {
|
---|
6946 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
6947 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
6948 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
6949 | #endif
|
---|
6950 |
|
---|
6951 | s_org (0);
|
---|
6952 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
6953 | }
|
---|
6954 |
|
---|
6955 | /* Handle a .PARAM pseudo-op. This is much like a .EXPORT, except it
|
---|
6956 | is for static functions. FIXME. Should share more code with .EXPORT. */
|
---|
6957 |
|
---|
6958 | static void
|
---|
6959 | pa_param (unused)
|
---|
6960 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6961 | {
|
---|
6962 | char *name, c, *p;
|
---|
6963 | symbolS *symbol;
|
---|
6964 |
|
---|
6965 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6966 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
6967 |
|
---|
6968 | if ((symbol = symbol_find_or_make (name)) == NULL)
|
---|
6969 | {
|
---|
6970 | as_bad (_("Cannot define static symbol: %s\n"), name);
|
---|
6971 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6972 | *p = c;
|
---|
6973 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6974 | }
|
---|
6975 | else
|
---|
6976 | {
|
---|
6977 | S_CLEAR_EXTERNAL (symbol);
|
---|
6978 | p = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
6979 | *p = c;
|
---|
6980 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
6981 | {
|
---|
6982 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
6983 | pa_type_args (symbol, 0);
|
---|
6984 | }
|
---|
6985 | }
|
---|
6986 |
|
---|
6987 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
6988 | }
|
---|
6989 |
|
---|
6990 | /* Handle a .PROC pseudo-op. It is used to mark the beginning
|
---|
6991 | of a procedure from a syntactical point of view. */
|
---|
6992 |
|
---|
6993 | static void
|
---|
6994 | pa_proc (unused)
|
---|
6995 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
6996 | {
|
---|
6997 | struct call_info *call_info;
|
---|
6998 |
|
---|
6999 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
7000 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
7001 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
7002 | #endif
|
---|
7003 |
|
---|
7004 | if (within_procedure)
|
---|
7005 | as_fatal (_("Nested procedures"));
|
---|
7006 |
|
---|
7007 | /* Reset global variables for new procedure. */
|
---|
7008 | callinfo_found = FALSE;
|
---|
7009 | within_procedure = TRUE;
|
---|
7010 |
|
---|
7011 | /* Create another call_info structure. */
|
---|
7012 | call_info = (struct call_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct call_info));
|
---|
7013 |
|
---|
7014 | if (!call_info)
|
---|
7015 | as_fatal (_("Cannot allocate unwind descriptor\n"));
|
---|
7016 |
|
---|
7017 | memset (call_info, 0, sizeof (struct call_info));
|
---|
7018 |
|
---|
7019 | call_info->ci_next = NULL;
|
---|
7020 |
|
---|
7021 | if (call_info_root == NULL)
|
---|
7022 | {
|
---|
7023 | call_info_root = call_info;
|
---|
7024 | last_call_info = call_info;
|
---|
7025 | }
|
---|
7026 | else
|
---|
7027 | {
|
---|
7028 | last_call_info->ci_next = call_info;
|
---|
7029 | last_call_info = call_info;
|
---|
7030 | }
|
---|
7031 |
|
---|
7032 | /* set up defaults on call_info structure */
|
---|
7033 |
|
---|
7034 | call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.cannot_unwind = 0;
|
---|
7035 | call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.region_desc = 1;
|
---|
7036 | call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor.hpux_interrupt_marker = 0;
|
---|
7037 |
|
---|
7038 | /* If we got a .PROC pseudo-op, we know that the function is defined
|
---|
7039 | locally. Make sure it gets into the symbol table. */
|
---|
7040 | {
|
---|
7041 | label_symbol_struct *label_symbol = pa_get_label ();
|
---|
7042 |
|
---|
7043 | if (label_symbol)
|
---|
7044 | {
|
---|
7045 | if (label_symbol->lss_label)
|
---|
7046 | {
|
---|
7047 | last_call_info->start_symbol = label_symbol->lss_label;
|
---|
7048 | symbol_get_bfdsym (label_symbol->lss_label)->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
7049 | }
|
---|
7050 | else
|
---|
7051 | as_bad (_("Missing function name for .PROC (corrupted label chain)"));
|
---|
7052 | }
|
---|
7053 | else
|
---|
7054 | last_call_info->start_symbol = NULL;
|
---|
7055 | }
|
---|
7056 |
|
---|
7057 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7058 | }
|
---|
7059 |
|
---|
7060 | /* Process the syntatical end of a procedure. Make sure all the
|
---|
7061 | appropriate pseudo-ops were found within the procedure. */
|
---|
7062 |
|
---|
7063 | static void
|
---|
7064 | pa_procend (unused)
|
---|
7065 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
7066 | {
|
---|
7067 |
|
---|
7068 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
7069 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
7070 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
7071 | #endif
|
---|
7072 |
|
---|
7073 | /* If we are within a procedure definition, make sure we've
|
---|
7074 | defined a label for the procedure; handle case where the
|
---|
7075 | label was defined after the .PROC directive.
|
---|
7076 |
|
---|
7077 | Note there's not need to diddle with the segment or fragment
|
---|
7078 | for the label symbol in this case. We have already switched
|
---|
7079 | into the new $CODE$ subspace at this point. */
|
---|
7080 | if (within_procedure && last_call_info->start_symbol == NULL)
|
---|
7081 | {
|
---|
7082 | label_symbol_struct *label_symbol = pa_get_label ();
|
---|
7083 |
|
---|
7084 | if (label_symbol)
|
---|
7085 | {
|
---|
7086 | if (label_symbol->lss_label)
|
---|
7087 | {
|
---|
7088 | last_call_info->start_symbol = label_symbol->lss_label;
|
---|
7089 | symbol_get_bfdsym (label_symbol->lss_label)->flags
|
---|
7090 | |= BSF_FUNCTION;
|
---|
7091 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
7092 | /* Also handle allocation of a fixup to hold the unwind
|
---|
7093 | information when the label appears after the proc/procend. */
|
---|
7094 | if (within_entry_exit)
|
---|
7095 | {
|
---|
7096 | char *where;
|
---|
7097 | unsigned int u;
|
---|
7098 |
|
---|
7099 | where = frag_more (0);
|
---|
7100 | u = UNWIND_LOW32 (&last_call_info->ci_unwind.descriptor);
|
---|
7101 | fix_new_hppa (frag_now, where - frag_now->fr_literal, 0,
|
---|
7102 | NULL, (offsetT) 0, NULL,
|
---|
7103 | 0, R_HPPA_ENTRY, e_fsel, 0, 0, u);
|
---|
7104 | }
|
---|
7105 | #endif
|
---|
7106 | }
|
---|
7107 | else
|
---|
7108 | as_bad (_("Missing function name for .PROC (corrupted label chain)"));
|
---|
7109 | }
|
---|
7110 | else
|
---|
7111 | as_bad (_("Missing function name for .PROC"));
|
---|
7112 | }
|
---|
7113 |
|
---|
7114 | if (!within_procedure)
|
---|
7115 | as_bad (_("misplaced .procend"));
|
---|
7116 |
|
---|
7117 | if (!callinfo_found)
|
---|
7118 | as_bad (_("Missing .callinfo for this procedure"));
|
---|
7119 |
|
---|
7120 | if (within_entry_exit)
|
---|
7121 | as_bad (_("Missing .EXIT for a .ENTRY"));
|
---|
7122 |
|
---|
7123 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
7124 | /* ELF needs to mark the end of each function so that it can compute
|
---|
7125 | the size of the function (apparently its needed in the symbol table). */
|
---|
7126 | hppa_elf_mark_end_of_function ();
|
---|
7127 | #endif
|
---|
7128 |
|
---|
7129 | within_procedure = FALSE;
|
---|
7130 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7131 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
7132 | }
|
---|
7133 |
|
---|
7134 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
7135 | /* If VALUE is an exact power of two between zero and 2^31, then
|
---|
7136 | return log2 (VALUE). Else return -1. */
|
---|
7137 |
|
---|
7138 | static int
|
---|
7139 | log2 (value)
|
---|
7140 | int value;
|
---|
7141 | {
|
---|
7142 | int shift = 0;
|
---|
7143 |
|
---|
7144 | while ((1 << shift) != value && shift < 32)
|
---|
7145 | shift++;
|
---|
7146 |
|
---|
7147 | if (shift >= 32)
|
---|
7148 | return -1;
|
---|
7149 | else
|
---|
7150 | return shift;
|
---|
7151 | }
|
---|
7152 |
|
---|
7153 | /* Check to make sure we have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
7154 |
|
---|
7155 | static void
|
---|
7156 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ()
|
---|
7157 | {
|
---|
7158 | if (current_space == NULL)
|
---|
7159 | as_fatal (_("Not in a space.\n"));
|
---|
7160 |
|
---|
7161 | if (current_subspace == NULL)
|
---|
7162 | as_fatal (_("Not in a subspace.\n"));
|
---|
7163 | }
|
---|
7164 |
|
---|
7165 | /* Parse the parameters to a .SPACE directive; if CREATE_FLAG is nonzero,
|
---|
7166 | then create a new space entry to hold the information specified
|
---|
7167 | by the parameters to the .SPACE directive. */
|
---|
7168 |
|
---|
7169 | static sd_chain_struct *
|
---|
7170 | pa_parse_space_stmt (space_name, create_flag)
|
---|
7171 | char *space_name;
|
---|
7172 | int create_flag;
|
---|
7173 | {
|
---|
7174 | char *name, *ptemp, c;
|
---|
7175 | char loadable, defined, private, sort;
|
---|
7176 | int spnum;
|
---|
7177 | asection *seg = NULL;
|
---|
7178 | sd_chain_struct *space;
|
---|
7179 |
|
---|
7180 | /* load default values */
|
---|
7181 | spnum = 0;
|
---|
7182 | sort = 0;
|
---|
7183 | loadable = TRUE;
|
---|
7184 | defined = TRUE;
|
---|
7185 | private = FALSE;
|
---|
7186 | if (strcmp (space_name, "$TEXT$") == 0)
|
---|
7187 | {
|
---|
7188 | seg = pa_def_spaces[0].segment;
|
---|
7189 | defined = pa_def_spaces[0].defined;
|
---|
7190 | private = pa_def_spaces[0].private;
|
---|
7191 | sort = pa_def_spaces[0].sort;
|
---|
7192 | spnum = pa_def_spaces[0].spnum;
|
---|
7193 | }
|
---|
7194 | else if (strcmp (space_name, "$PRIVATE$") == 0)
|
---|
7195 | {
|
---|
7196 | seg = pa_def_spaces[1].segment;
|
---|
7197 | defined = pa_def_spaces[1].defined;
|
---|
7198 | private = pa_def_spaces[1].private;
|
---|
7199 | sort = pa_def_spaces[1].sort;
|
---|
7200 | spnum = pa_def_spaces[1].spnum;
|
---|
7201 | }
|
---|
7202 |
|
---|
7203 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
7204 | {
|
---|
7205 | print_errors = FALSE;
|
---|
7206 | ptemp = input_line_pointer + 1;
|
---|
7207 | /* First see if the space was specified as a number rather than
|
---|
7208 | as a name. According to the PA assembly manual the rest of
|
---|
7209 | the line should be ignored. */
|
---|
7210 | strict = 0;
|
---|
7211 | pa_parse_number (&ptemp, 0);
|
---|
7212 | if (pa_number >= 0)
|
---|
7213 | {
|
---|
7214 | spnum = pa_number;
|
---|
7215 | input_line_pointer = ptemp;
|
---|
7216 | }
|
---|
7217 | else
|
---|
7218 | {
|
---|
7219 | while (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
7220 | {
|
---|
7221 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7222 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
7223 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
7224 | if ((strncasecmp (name, "spnum", 5) == 0))
|
---|
7225 | {
|
---|
7226 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7227 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7228 | spnum = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
7229 | }
|
---|
7230 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "sort", 4) == 0))
|
---|
7231 | {
|
---|
7232 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7233 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7234 | sort = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
7235 | }
|
---|
7236 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "unloadable", 10) == 0))
|
---|
7237 | {
|
---|
7238 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7239 | loadable = FALSE;
|
---|
7240 | }
|
---|
7241 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "notdefined", 10) == 0))
|
---|
7242 | {
|
---|
7243 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7244 | defined = FALSE;
|
---|
7245 | }
|
---|
7246 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "private", 7) == 0))
|
---|
7247 | {
|
---|
7248 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7249 | private = TRUE;
|
---|
7250 | }
|
---|
7251 | else
|
---|
7252 | {
|
---|
7253 | as_bad (_("Invalid .SPACE argument"));
|
---|
7254 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7255 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
7256 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7257 | }
|
---|
7258 | }
|
---|
7259 | }
|
---|
7260 | print_errors = TRUE;
|
---|
7261 | }
|
---|
7262 |
|
---|
7263 | if (create_flag && seg == NULL)
|
---|
7264 | seg = subseg_new (space_name, 0);
|
---|
7265 |
|
---|
7266 | /* If create_flag is nonzero, then create the new space with
|
---|
7267 | the attributes computed above. Else set the values in
|
---|
7268 | an already existing space -- this can only happen for
|
---|
7269 | the first occurence of a built-in space. */
|
---|
7270 | if (create_flag)
|
---|
7271 | space = create_new_space (space_name, spnum, loadable, defined,
|
---|
7272 | private, sort, seg, 1);
|
---|
7273 | else
|
---|
7274 | {
|
---|
7275 | space = is_defined_space (space_name);
|
---|
7276 | SPACE_SPNUM (space) = spnum;
|
---|
7277 | SPACE_DEFINED (space) = defined & 1;
|
---|
7278 | SPACE_USER_DEFINED (space) = 1;
|
---|
7279 | }
|
---|
7280 |
|
---|
7281 | #ifdef obj_set_section_attributes
|
---|
7282 | obj_set_section_attributes (seg, defined, private, sort, spnum);
|
---|
7283 | #endif
|
---|
7284 |
|
---|
7285 | return space;
|
---|
7286 | }
|
---|
7287 |
|
---|
7288 | /* Handle a .SPACE pseudo-op; this switches the current space to the
|
---|
7289 | given space, creating the new space if necessary. */
|
---|
7290 |
|
---|
7291 | static void
|
---|
7292 | pa_space (unused)
|
---|
7293 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
7294 | {
|
---|
7295 | char *name, c, *space_name, *save_s;
|
---|
7296 | sd_chain_struct *sd_chain;
|
---|
7297 |
|
---|
7298 | if (within_procedure)
|
---|
7299 | {
|
---|
7300 | as_bad (_("Can\'t change spaces within a procedure definition. Ignored"));
|
---|
7301 | ignore_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7302 | }
|
---|
7303 | else
|
---|
7304 | {
|
---|
7305 | /* Check for some of the predefined spaces. FIXME: most of the code
|
---|
7306 | below is repeated several times, can we extract the common parts
|
---|
7307 | and place them into a subroutine or something similar? */
|
---|
7308 | /* FIXME Is this (and the next IF stmt) really right?
|
---|
7309 | What if INPUT_LINE_POINTER points to "$TEXT$FOO"? */
|
---|
7310 | if (strncmp (input_line_pointer, "$TEXT$", 6) == 0)
|
---|
7311 | {
|
---|
7312 | input_line_pointer += 6;
|
---|
7313 | sd_chain = is_defined_space ("$TEXT$");
|
---|
7314 | if (sd_chain == NULL)
|
---|
7315 | sd_chain = pa_parse_space_stmt ("$TEXT$", 1);
|
---|
7316 | else if (SPACE_USER_DEFINED (sd_chain) == 0)
|
---|
7317 | sd_chain = pa_parse_space_stmt ("$TEXT$", 0);
|
---|
7318 |
|
---|
7319 | current_space = sd_chain;
|
---|
7320 | subseg_set (text_section, sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7321 | current_subspace
|
---|
7322 | = pa_subsegment_to_subspace (text_section,
|
---|
7323 | sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7324 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7325 | return;
|
---|
7326 | }
|
---|
7327 | if (strncmp (input_line_pointer, "$PRIVATE$", 9) == 0)
|
---|
7328 | {
|
---|
7329 | input_line_pointer += 9;
|
---|
7330 | sd_chain = is_defined_space ("$PRIVATE$");
|
---|
7331 | if (sd_chain == NULL)
|
---|
7332 | sd_chain = pa_parse_space_stmt ("$PRIVATE$", 1);
|
---|
7333 | else if (SPACE_USER_DEFINED (sd_chain) == 0)
|
---|
7334 | sd_chain = pa_parse_space_stmt ("$PRIVATE$", 0);
|
---|
7335 |
|
---|
7336 | current_space = sd_chain;
|
---|
7337 | subseg_set (data_section, sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7338 | current_subspace
|
---|
7339 | = pa_subsegment_to_subspace (data_section,
|
---|
7340 | sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7341 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7342 | return;
|
---|
7343 | }
|
---|
7344 | if (!strncasecmp (input_line_pointer,
|
---|
7345 | GDB_DEBUG_SPACE_NAME,
|
---|
7346 | strlen (GDB_DEBUG_SPACE_NAME)))
|
---|
7347 | {
|
---|
7348 | input_line_pointer += strlen (GDB_DEBUG_SPACE_NAME);
|
---|
7349 | sd_chain = is_defined_space (GDB_DEBUG_SPACE_NAME);
|
---|
7350 | if (sd_chain == NULL)
|
---|
7351 | sd_chain = pa_parse_space_stmt (GDB_DEBUG_SPACE_NAME, 1);
|
---|
7352 | else if (SPACE_USER_DEFINED (sd_chain) == 0)
|
---|
7353 | sd_chain = pa_parse_space_stmt (GDB_DEBUG_SPACE_NAME, 0);
|
---|
7354 |
|
---|
7355 | current_space = sd_chain;
|
---|
7356 |
|
---|
7357 | {
|
---|
7358 | asection *gdb_section
|
---|
7359 | = bfd_make_section_old_way (stdoutput, GDB_DEBUG_SPACE_NAME);
|
---|
7360 |
|
---|
7361 | subseg_set (gdb_section, sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7362 | current_subspace
|
---|
7363 | = pa_subsegment_to_subspace (gdb_section,
|
---|
7364 | sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7365 | }
|
---|
7366 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7367 | return;
|
---|
7368 | }
|
---|
7369 |
|
---|
7370 | /* It could be a space specified by number. */
|
---|
7371 | print_errors = 0;
|
---|
7372 | save_s = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
7373 | strict = 0;
|
---|
7374 | pa_parse_number (&input_line_pointer, 0);
|
---|
7375 | if (pa_number >= 0)
|
---|
7376 | {
|
---|
7377 | if ((sd_chain = pa_find_space_by_number (pa_number)))
|
---|
7378 | {
|
---|
7379 | current_space = sd_chain;
|
---|
7380 |
|
---|
7381 | subseg_set (sd_chain->sd_seg, sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7382 | current_subspace
|
---|
7383 | = pa_subsegment_to_subspace (sd_chain->sd_seg,
|
---|
7384 | sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7385 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7386 | return;
|
---|
7387 | }
|
---|
7388 | }
|
---|
7389 |
|
---|
7390 | /* Not a number, attempt to create a new space. */
|
---|
7391 | print_errors = 1;
|
---|
7392 | input_line_pointer = save_s;
|
---|
7393 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
7394 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
7395 | space_name = xmalloc (strlen (name) + 1);
|
---|
7396 | strcpy (space_name, name);
|
---|
7397 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7398 |
|
---|
7399 | sd_chain = pa_parse_space_stmt (space_name, 1);
|
---|
7400 | current_space = sd_chain;
|
---|
7401 |
|
---|
7402 | subseg_set (sd_chain->sd_seg, sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7403 | current_subspace = pa_subsegment_to_subspace (sd_chain->sd_seg,
|
---|
7404 | sd_chain->sd_last_subseg);
|
---|
7405 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7406 | }
|
---|
7407 | }
|
---|
7408 |
|
---|
7409 | /* Switch to a new space. (I think). FIXME. */
|
---|
7410 |
|
---|
7411 | static void
|
---|
7412 | pa_spnum (unused)
|
---|
7413 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
7414 | {
|
---|
7415 | char *name;
|
---|
7416 | char c;
|
---|
7417 | char *p;
|
---|
7418 | sd_chain_struct *space;
|
---|
7419 |
|
---|
7420 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
7421 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
7422 | space = is_defined_space (name);
|
---|
7423 | if (space)
|
---|
7424 | {
|
---|
7425 | p = frag_more (4);
|
---|
7426 | md_number_to_chars (p, SPACE_SPNUM (space), 4);
|
---|
7427 | }
|
---|
7428 | else
|
---|
7429 | as_warn (_("Undefined space: '%s' Assuming space number = 0."), name);
|
---|
7430 |
|
---|
7431 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7432 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7433 | }
|
---|
7434 |
|
---|
7435 | /* Handle a .SUBSPACE pseudo-op; this switches the current subspace to the
|
---|
7436 | given subspace, creating the new subspace if necessary.
|
---|
7437 |
|
---|
7438 | FIXME. Should mirror pa_space more closely, in particular how
|
---|
7439 | they're broken up into subroutines. */
|
---|
7440 |
|
---|
7441 | static void
|
---|
7442 | pa_subspace (create_new)
|
---|
7443 | int create_new;
|
---|
7444 | {
|
---|
7445 | char *name, *ss_name, c;
|
---|
7446 | char loadable, code_only, common, dup_common, zero, sort;
|
---|
7447 | int i, access, space_index, alignment, quadrant, applicable, flags;
|
---|
7448 | sd_chain_struct *space;
|
---|
7449 | ssd_chain_struct *ssd;
|
---|
7450 | asection *section;
|
---|
7451 |
|
---|
7452 | if (current_space == NULL)
|
---|
7453 | as_fatal (_("Must be in a space before changing or declaring subspaces.\n"));
|
---|
7454 |
|
---|
7455 | if (within_procedure)
|
---|
7456 | {
|
---|
7457 | as_bad (_("Can\'t change subspaces within a procedure definition. Ignored"));
|
---|
7458 | ignore_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7459 | }
|
---|
7460 | else
|
---|
7461 | {
|
---|
7462 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
7463 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
7464 | ss_name = xmalloc (strlen (name) + 1);
|
---|
7465 | strcpy (ss_name, name);
|
---|
7466 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7467 |
|
---|
7468 | /* Load default values. */
|
---|
7469 | sort = 0;
|
---|
7470 | access = 0x7f;
|
---|
7471 | loadable = 1;
|
---|
7472 | common = 0;
|
---|
7473 | dup_common = 0;
|
---|
7474 | code_only = 0;
|
---|
7475 | zero = 0;
|
---|
7476 | space_index = ~0;
|
---|
7477 | alignment = 1;
|
---|
7478 | quadrant = 0;
|
---|
7479 |
|
---|
7480 | space = current_space;
|
---|
7481 | if (create_new)
|
---|
7482 | ssd = NULL;
|
---|
7483 | else
|
---|
7484 | ssd = is_defined_subspace (ss_name);
|
---|
7485 | /* Allow user to override the builtin attributes of subspaces. But
|
---|
7486 | only allow the attributes to be changed once! */
|
---|
7487 | if (ssd && SUBSPACE_DEFINED (ssd))
|
---|
7488 | {
|
---|
7489 | subseg_set (ssd->ssd_seg, ssd->ssd_subseg);
|
---|
7490 | current_subspace = ssd;
|
---|
7491 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
7492 | as_warn (_("Parameters of an existing subspace can\'t be modified"));
|
---|
7493 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7494 | return;
|
---|
7495 | }
|
---|
7496 | else
|
---|
7497 | {
|
---|
7498 | /* A new subspace. Load default values if it matches one of
|
---|
7499 | the builtin subspaces. */
|
---|
7500 | i = 0;
|
---|
7501 | while (pa_def_subspaces[i].name)
|
---|
7502 | {
|
---|
7503 | if (strcasecmp (pa_def_subspaces[i].name, ss_name) == 0)
|
---|
7504 | {
|
---|
7505 | loadable = pa_def_subspaces[i].loadable;
|
---|
7506 | common = pa_def_subspaces[i].common;
|
---|
7507 | dup_common = pa_def_subspaces[i].dup_common;
|
---|
7508 | code_only = pa_def_subspaces[i].code_only;
|
---|
7509 | zero = pa_def_subspaces[i].zero;
|
---|
7510 | space_index = pa_def_subspaces[i].space_index;
|
---|
7511 | alignment = pa_def_subspaces[i].alignment;
|
---|
7512 | quadrant = pa_def_subspaces[i].quadrant;
|
---|
7513 | access = pa_def_subspaces[i].access;
|
---|
7514 | sort = pa_def_subspaces[i].sort;
|
---|
7515 | break;
|
---|
7516 | }
|
---|
7517 | i++;
|
---|
7518 | }
|
---|
7519 | }
|
---|
7520 |
|
---|
7521 | /* We should be working with a new subspace now. Fill in
|
---|
7522 | any information as specified by the user. */
|
---|
7523 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
7524 | {
|
---|
7525 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7526 | while (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
7527 | {
|
---|
7528 | name = input_line_pointer;
|
---|
7529 | c = get_symbol_end ();
|
---|
7530 | if ((strncasecmp (name, "quad", 4) == 0))
|
---|
7531 | {
|
---|
7532 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7533 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7534 | quadrant = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
7535 | }
|
---|
7536 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "align", 5) == 0))
|
---|
7537 | {
|
---|
7538 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7539 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7540 | alignment = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
7541 | if (log2 (alignment) == -1)
|
---|
7542 | {
|
---|
7543 | as_bad (_("Alignment must be a power of 2"));
|
---|
7544 | alignment = 1;
|
---|
7545 | }
|
---|
7546 | }
|
---|
7547 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "access", 6) == 0))
|
---|
7548 | {
|
---|
7549 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7550 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7551 | access = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
7552 | }
|
---|
7553 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "sort", 4) == 0))
|
---|
7554 | {
|
---|
7555 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7556 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7557 | sort = get_absolute_expression ();
|
---|
7558 | }
|
---|
7559 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "code_only", 9) == 0))
|
---|
7560 | {
|
---|
7561 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7562 | code_only = 1;
|
---|
7563 | }
|
---|
7564 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "unloadable", 10) == 0))
|
---|
7565 | {
|
---|
7566 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7567 | loadable = 0;
|
---|
7568 | }
|
---|
7569 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "common", 6) == 0))
|
---|
7570 | {
|
---|
7571 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7572 | common = 1;
|
---|
7573 | }
|
---|
7574 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "dup_comm", 8) == 0))
|
---|
7575 | {
|
---|
7576 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7577 | dup_common = 1;
|
---|
7578 | }
|
---|
7579 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "zero", 4) == 0))
|
---|
7580 | {
|
---|
7581 | *input_line_pointer = c;
|
---|
7582 | zero = 1;
|
---|
7583 | }
|
---|
7584 | else if ((strncasecmp (name, "first", 5) == 0))
|
---|
7585 | as_bad (_("FIRST not supported as a .SUBSPACE argument"));
|
---|
7586 | else
|
---|
7587 | as_bad (_("Invalid .SUBSPACE argument"));
|
---|
7588 | if (!is_end_of_statement ())
|
---|
7589 | input_line_pointer++;
|
---|
7590 | }
|
---|
7591 | }
|
---|
7592 |
|
---|
7593 | /* Compute a reasonable set of BFD flags based on the information
|
---|
7594 | in the .subspace directive. */
|
---|
7595 | applicable = bfd_applicable_section_flags (stdoutput);
|
---|
7596 | flags = 0;
|
---|
7597 | if (loadable)
|
---|
7598 | flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD);
|
---|
7599 | if (code_only)
|
---|
7600 | flags |= SEC_CODE;
|
---|
7601 | if (common || dup_common)
|
---|
7602 | flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
|
---|
7603 |
|
---|
7604 | flags |= SEC_RELOC | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
|
---|
7605 |
|
---|
7606 | /* This is a zero-filled subspace (eg BSS). */
|
---|
7607 | if (zero)
|
---|
7608 | flags &= ~(SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
|
---|
7609 |
|
---|
7610 | applicable &= flags;
|
---|
7611 |
|
---|
7612 | /* If this is an existing subspace, then we want to use the
|
---|
7613 | segment already associated with the subspace.
|
---|
7614 |
|
---|
7615 | FIXME NOW! ELF BFD doesn't appear to be ready to deal with
|
---|
7616 | lots of sections. It might be a problem in the PA ELF
|
---|
7617 | code, I do not know yet. For now avoid creating anything
|
---|
7618 | but the "standard" sections for ELF. */
|
---|
7619 | if (create_new)
|
---|
7620 | section = subseg_force_new (ss_name, 0);
|
---|
7621 | else if (ssd)
|
---|
7622 | section = ssd->ssd_seg;
|
---|
7623 | else
|
---|
7624 | section = subseg_new (ss_name, 0);
|
---|
7625 |
|
---|
7626 | if (zero)
|
---|
7627 | seg_info (section)->bss = 1;
|
---|
7628 |
|
---|
7629 | /* Now set the flags. */
|
---|
7630 | bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, section, applicable);
|
---|
7631 |
|
---|
7632 | /* Record any alignment request for this section. */
|
---|
7633 | record_alignment (section, log2 (alignment));
|
---|
7634 |
|
---|
7635 | /* Set the starting offset for this section. */
|
---|
7636 | bfd_set_section_vma (stdoutput, section,
|
---|
7637 | pa_subspace_start (space, quadrant));
|
---|
7638 |
|
---|
7639 | /* Now that all the flags are set, update an existing subspace,
|
---|
7640 | or create a new one. */
|
---|
7641 | if (ssd)
|
---|
7642 |
|
---|
7643 | current_subspace = update_subspace (space, ss_name, loadable,
|
---|
7644 | code_only, common, dup_common,
|
---|
7645 | sort, zero, access, space_index,
|
---|
7646 | alignment, quadrant,
|
---|
7647 | section);
|
---|
7648 | else
|
---|
7649 | current_subspace = create_new_subspace (space, ss_name, loadable,
|
---|
7650 | code_only, common,
|
---|
7651 | dup_common, zero, sort,
|
---|
7652 | access, space_index,
|
---|
7653 | alignment, quadrant, section);
|
---|
7654 |
|
---|
7655 | demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
|
---|
7656 | current_subspace->ssd_seg = section;
|
---|
7657 | subseg_set (current_subspace->ssd_seg, current_subspace->ssd_subseg);
|
---|
7658 | }
|
---|
7659 | SUBSPACE_DEFINED (current_subspace) = 1;
|
---|
7660 | }
|
---|
7661 |
|
---|
7662 | /* Create default space and subspace dictionaries. */
|
---|
7663 |
|
---|
7664 | static void
|
---|
7665 | pa_spaces_begin ()
|
---|
7666 | {
|
---|
7667 | int i;
|
---|
7668 |
|
---|
7669 | space_dict_root = NULL;
|
---|
7670 | space_dict_last = NULL;
|
---|
7671 |
|
---|
7672 | i = 0;
|
---|
7673 | while (pa_def_spaces[i].name)
|
---|
7674 | {
|
---|
7675 | char *name;
|
---|
7676 |
|
---|
7677 | /* Pick the right name to use for the new section. */
|
---|
7678 | name = pa_def_spaces[i].name;
|
---|
7679 |
|
---|
7680 | pa_def_spaces[i].segment = subseg_new (name, 0);
|
---|
7681 | create_new_space (pa_def_spaces[i].name, pa_def_spaces[i].spnum,
|
---|
7682 | pa_def_spaces[i].loadable, pa_def_spaces[i].defined,
|
---|
7683 | pa_def_spaces[i].private, pa_def_spaces[i].sort,
|
---|
7684 | pa_def_spaces[i].segment, 0);
|
---|
7685 | i++;
|
---|
7686 | }
|
---|
7687 |
|
---|
7688 | i = 0;
|
---|
7689 | while (pa_def_subspaces[i].name)
|
---|
7690 | {
|
---|
7691 | char *name;
|
---|
7692 | int applicable, subsegment;
|
---|
7693 | asection *segment = NULL;
|
---|
7694 | sd_chain_struct *space;
|
---|
7695 |
|
---|
7696 | /* Pick the right name for the new section and pick the right
|
---|
7697 | subsegment number. */
|
---|
7698 | name = pa_def_subspaces[i].name;
|
---|
7699 | subsegment = 0;
|
---|
7700 |
|
---|
7701 | /* Create the new section. */
|
---|
7702 | segment = subseg_new (name, subsegment);
|
---|
7703 |
|
---|
7704 | /* For SOM we want to replace the standard .text, .data, and .bss
|
---|
7705 | sections with our own. We also want to set BFD flags for
|
---|
7706 | all the built-in subspaces. */
|
---|
7707 | if (!strcmp (pa_def_subspaces[i].name, "$CODE$"))
|
---|
7708 | {
|
---|
7709 | text_section = segment;
|
---|
7710 | applicable = bfd_applicable_section_flags (stdoutput);
|
---|
7711 | bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, segment,
|
---|
7712 | applicable & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
|
---|
7713 | | SEC_RELOC | SEC_CODE
|
---|
7714 | | SEC_READONLY
|
---|
7715 | | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS));
|
---|
7716 | }
|
---|
7717 | else if (!strcmp (pa_def_subspaces[i].name, "$DATA$"))
|
---|
7718 | {
|
---|
7719 | data_section = segment;
|
---|
7720 | applicable = bfd_applicable_section_flags (stdoutput);
|
---|
7721 | bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, segment,
|
---|
7722 | applicable & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
|
---|
7723 | | SEC_RELOC
|
---|
7724 | | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS));
|
---|
7725 |
|
---|
7726 | }
|
---|
7727 | else if (!strcmp (pa_def_subspaces[i].name, "$BSS$"))
|
---|
7728 | {
|
---|
7729 | bss_section = segment;
|
---|
7730 | applicable = bfd_applicable_section_flags (stdoutput);
|
---|
7731 | bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, segment,
|
---|
7732 | applicable & SEC_ALLOC);
|
---|
7733 | }
|
---|
7734 | else if (!strcmp (pa_def_subspaces[i].name, "$LIT$"))
|
---|
7735 | {
|
---|
7736 | applicable = bfd_applicable_section_flags (stdoutput);
|
---|
7737 | bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, segment,
|
---|
7738 | applicable & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
|
---|
7739 | | SEC_RELOC
|
---|
7740 | | SEC_READONLY
|
---|
7741 | | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS));
|
---|
7742 | }
|
---|
7743 | else if (!strcmp (pa_def_subspaces[i].name, "$MILLICODE$"))
|
---|
7744 | {
|
---|
7745 | applicable = bfd_applicable_section_flags (stdoutput);
|
---|
7746 | bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, segment,
|
---|
7747 | applicable & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
|
---|
7748 | | SEC_RELOC
|
---|
7749 | | SEC_READONLY
|
---|
7750 | | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS));
|
---|
7751 | }
|
---|
7752 | else if (!strcmp (pa_def_subspaces[i].name, "$UNWIND$"))
|
---|
7753 | {
|
---|
7754 | applicable = bfd_applicable_section_flags (stdoutput);
|
---|
7755 | bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, segment,
|
---|
7756 | applicable & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
|
---|
7757 | | SEC_RELOC
|
---|
7758 | | SEC_READONLY
|
---|
7759 | | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS));
|
---|
7760 | }
|
---|
7761 |
|
---|
7762 | /* Find the space associated with this subspace. */
|
---|
7763 | space = pa_segment_to_space (pa_def_spaces[pa_def_subspaces[i].
|
---|
7764 | def_space_index].segment);
|
---|
7765 | if (space == NULL)
|
---|
7766 | {
|
---|
7767 | as_fatal (_("Internal error: Unable to find containing space for %s."),
|
---|
7768 | pa_def_subspaces[i].name);
|
---|
7769 | }
|
---|
7770 |
|
---|
7771 | create_new_subspace (space, name,
|
---|
7772 | pa_def_subspaces[i].loadable,
|
---|
7773 | pa_def_subspaces[i].code_only,
|
---|
7774 | pa_def_subspaces[i].common,
|
---|
7775 | pa_def_subspaces[i].dup_common,
|
---|
7776 | pa_def_subspaces[i].zero,
|
---|
7777 | pa_def_subspaces[i].sort,
|
---|
7778 | pa_def_subspaces[i].access,
|
---|
7779 | pa_def_subspaces[i].space_index,
|
---|
7780 | pa_def_subspaces[i].alignment,
|
---|
7781 | pa_def_subspaces[i].quadrant,
|
---|
7782 | segment);
|
---|
7783 | i++;
|
---|
7784 | }
|
---|
7785 | }
|
---|
7786 |
|
---|
7787 | /* Create a new space NAME, with the appropriate flags as defined
|
---|
7788 | by the given parameters. */
|
---|
7789 |
|
---|
7790 | static sd_chain_struct *
|
---|
7791 | create_new_space (name, spnum, loadable, defined, private,
|
---|
7792 | sort, seg, user_defined)
|
---|
7793 | char *name;
|
---|
7794 | int spnum;
|
---|
7795 | int loadable;
|
---|
7796 | int defined;
|
---|
7797 | int private;
|
---|
7798 | int sort;
|
---|
7799 | asection *seg;
|
---|
7800 | int user_defined;
|
---|
7801 | {
|
---|
7802 | sd_chain_struct *chain_entry;
|
---|
7803 |
|
---|
7804 | chain_entry = (sd_chain_struct *) xmalloc (sizeof (sd_chain_struct));
|
---|
7805 | if (!chain_entry)
|
---|
7806 | as_fatal (_("Out of memory: could not allocate new space chain entry: %s\n"),
|
---|
7807 | name);
|
---|
7808 |
|
---|
7809 | SPACE_NAME (chain_entry) = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (name) + 1);
|
---|
7810 | strcpy (SPACE_NAME (chain_entry), name);
|
---|
7811 | SPACE_DEFINED (chain_entry) = defined;
|
---|
7812 | SPACE_USER_DEFINED (chain_entry) = user_defined;
|
---|
7813 | SPACE_SPNUM (chain_entry) = spnum;
|
---|
7814 |
|
---|
7815 | chain_entry->sd_seg = seg;
|
---|
7816 | chain_entry->sd_last_subseg = -1;
|
---|
7817 | chain_entry->sd_subspaces = NULL;
|
---|
7818 | chain_entry->sd_next = NULL;
|
---|
7819 |
|
---|
7820 | /* Find spot for the new space based on its sort key. */
|
---|
7821 | if (!space_dict_last)
|
---|
7822 | space_dict_last = chain_entry;
|
---|
7823 |
|
---|
7824 | if (space_dict_root == NULL)
|
---|
7825 | space_dict_root = chain_entry;
|
---|
7826 | else
|
---|
7827 | {
|
---|
7828 | sd_chain_struct *chain_pointer;
|
---|
7829 | sd_chain_struct *prev_chain_pointer;
|
---|
7830 |
|
---|
7831 | chain_pointer = space_dict_root;
|
---|
7832 | prev_chain_pointer = NULL;
|
---|
7833 |
|
---|
7834 | while (chain_pointer)
|
---|
7835 | {
|
---|
7836 | prev_chain_pointer = chain_pointer;
|
---|
7837 | chain_pointer = chain_pointer->sd_next;
|
---|
7838 | }
|
---|
7839 |
|
---|
7840 | /* At this point we've found the correct place to add the new
|
---|
7841 | entry. So add it and update the linked lists as appropriate. */
|
---|
7842 | if (prev_chain_pointer)
|
---|
7843 | {
|
---|
7844 | chain_entry->sd_next = chain_pointer;
|
---|
7845 | prev_chain_pointer->sd_next = chain_entry;
|
---|
7846 | }
|
---|
7847 | else
|
---|
7848 | {
|
---|
7849 | space_dict_root = chain_entry;
|
---|
7850 | chain_entry->sd_next = chain_pointer;
|
---|
7851 | }
|
---|
7852 |
|
---|
7853 | if (chain_entry->sd_next == NULL)
|
---|
7854 | space_dict_last = chain_entry;
|
---|
7855 | }
|
---|
7856 |
|
---|
7857 | /* This is here to catch predefined spaces which do not get
|
---|
7858 | modified by the user's input. Another call is found at
|
---|
7859 | the bottom of pa_parse_space_stmt to handle cases where
|
---|
7860 | the user modifies a predefined space. */
|
---|
7861 | #ifdef obj_set_section_attributes
|
---|
7862 | obj_set_section_attributes (seg, defined, private, sort, spnum);
|
---|
7863 | #endif
|
---|
7864 |
|
---|
7865 | return chain_entry;
|
---|
7866 | }
|
---|
7867 |
|
---|
7868 | /* Create a new subspace NAME, with the appropriate flags as defined
|
---|
7869 | by the given parameters.
|
---|
7870 |
|
---|
7871 | Add the new subspace to the subspace dictionary chain in numerical
|
---|
7872 | order as defined by the SORT entries. */
|
---|
7873 |
|
---|
7874 | static ssd_chain_struct *
|
---|
7875 | create_new_subspace (space, name, loadable, code_only, common,
|
---|
7876 | dup_common, is_zero, sort, access, space_index,
|
---|
7877 | alignment, quadrant, seg)
|
---|
7878 | sd_chain_struct *space;
|
---|
7879 | char *name;
|
---|
7880 | int loadable, code_only, common, dup_common, is_zero;
|
---|
7881 | int sort;
|
---|
7882 | int access;
|
---|
7883 | int space_index;
|
---|
7884 | int alignment;
|
---|
7885 | int quadrant;
|
---|
7886 | asection *seg;
|
---|
7887 | {
|
---|
7888 | ssd_chain_struct *chain_entry;
|
---|
7889 |
|
---|
7890 | chain_entry = (ssd_chain_struct *) xmalloc (sizeof (ssd_chain_struct));
|
---|
7891 | if (!chain_entry)
|
---|
7892 | as_fatal (_("Out of memory: could not allocate new subspace chain entry: %s\n"), name);
|
---|
7893 |
|
---|
7894 | SUBSPACE_NAME (chain_entry) = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (name) + 1);
|
---|
7895 | strcpy (SUBSPACE_NAME (chain_entry), name);
|
---|
7896 |
|
---|
7897 | /* Initialize subspace_defined. When we hit a .subspace directive
|
---|
7898 | we'll set it to 1 which "locks-in" the subspace attributes. */
|
---|
7899 | SUBSPACE_DEFINED (chain_entry) = 0;
|
---|
7900 |
|
---|
7901 | chain_entry->ssd_subseg = 0;
|
---|
7902 | chain_entry->ssd_seg = seg;
|
---|
7903 | chain_entry->ssd_next = NULL;
|
---|
7904 |
|
---|
7905 | /* Find spot for the new subspace based on its sort key. */
|
---|
7906 | if (space->sd_subspaces == NULL)
|
---|
7907 | space->sd_subspaces = chain_entry;
|
---|
7908 | else
|
---|
7909 | {
|
---|
7910 | ssd_chain_struct *chain_pointer;
|
---|
7911 | ssd_chain_struct *prev_chain_pointer;
|
---|
7912 |
|
---|
7913 | chain_pointer = space->sd_subspaces;
|
---|
7914 | prev_chain_pointer = NULL;
|
---|
7915 |
|
---|
7916 | while (chain_pointer)
|
---|
7917 | {
|
---|
7918 | prev_chain_pointer = chain_pointer;
|
---|
7919 | chain_pointer = chain_pointer->ssd_next;
|
---|
7920 | }
|
---|
7921 |
|
---|
7922 | /* Now we have somewhere to put the new entry. Insert it and update
|
---|
7923 | the links. */
|
---|
7924 | if (prev_chain_pointer)
|
---|
7925 | {
|
---|
7926 | chain_entry->ssd_next = chain_pointer;
|
---|
7927 | prev_chain_pointer->ssd_next = chain_entry;
|
---|
7928 | }
|
---|
7929 | else
|
---|
7930 | {
|
---|
7931 | space->sd_subspaces = chain_entry;
|
---|
7932 | chain_entry->ssd_next = chain_pointer;
|
---|
7933 | }
|
---|
7934 | }
|
---|
7935 |
|
---|
7936 | #ifdef obj_set_subsection_attributes
|
---|
7937 | obj_set_subsection_attributes (seg, space->sd_seg, access,
|
---|
7938 | sort, quadrant);
|
---|
7939 | #endif
|
---|
7940 |
|
---|
7941 | return chain_entry;
|
---|
7942 | }
|
---|
7943 |
|
---|
7944 | /* Update the information for the given subspace based upon the
|
---|
7945 | various arguments. Return the modified subspace chain entry. */
|
---|
7946 |
|
---|
7947 | static ssd_chain_struct *
|
---|
7948 | update_subspace (space, name, loadable, code_only, common, dup_common, sort,
|
---|
7949 | zero, access, space_index, alignment, quadrant, section)
|
---|
7950 | sd_chain_struct *space;
|
---|
7951 | char *name;
|
---|
7952 | int loadable;
|
---|
7953 | int code_only;
|
---|
7954 | int common;
|
---|
7955 | int dup_common;
|
---|
7956 | int zero;
|
---|
7957 | int sort;
|
---|
7958 | int access;
|
---|
7959 | int space_index;
|
---|
7960 | int alignment;
|
---|
7961 | int quadrant;
|
---|
7962 | asection *section;
|
---|
7963 | {
|
---|
7964 | ssd_chain_struct *chain_entry;
|
---|
7965 |
|
---|
7966 | chain_entry = is_defined_subspace (name);
|
---|
7967 |
|
---|
7968 | #ifdef obj_set_subsection_attributes
|
---|
7969 | obj_set_subsection_attributes (section, space->sd_seg, access,
|
---|
7970 | sort, quadrant);
|
---|
7971 | #endif
|
---|
7972 |
|
---|
7973 | return chain_entry;
|
---|
7974 | }
|
---|
7975 |
|
---|
7976 | /* Return the space chain entry for the space with the name NAME or
|
---|
7977 | NULL if no such space exists. */
|
---|
7978 |
|
---|
7979 | static sd_chain_struct *
|
---|
7980 | is_defined_space (name)
|
---|
7981 | char *name;
|
---|
7982 | {
|
---|
7983 | sd_chain_struct *chain_pointer;
|
---|
7984 |
|
---|
7985 | for (chain_pointer = space_dict_root;
|
---|
7986 | chain_pointer;
|
---|
7987 | chain_pointer = chain_pointer->sd_next)
|
---|
7988 | {
|
---|
7989 | if (strcmp (SPACE_NAME (chain_pointer), name) == 0)
|
---|
7990 | return chain_pointer;
|
---|
7991 | }
|
---|
7992 |
|
---|
7993 | /* No mapping from segment to space was found. Return NULL. */
|
---|
7994 | return NULL;
|
---|
7995 | }
|
---|
7996 |
|
---|
7997 | /* Find and return the space associated with the given seg. If no mapping
|
---|
7998 | from the given seg to a space is found, then return NULL.
|
---|
7999 |
|
---|
8000 | Unlike subspaces, the number of spaces is not expected to grow much,
|
---|
8001 | so a linear exhaustive search is OK here. */
|
---|
8002 |
|
---|
8003 | static sd_chain_struct *
|
---|
8004 | pa_segment_to_space (seg)
|
---|
8005 | asection *seg;
|
---|
8006 | {
|
---|
8007 | sd_chain_struct *space_chain;
|
---|
8008 |
|
---|
8009 | /* Walk through each space looking for the correct mapping. */
|
---|
8010 | for (space_chain = space_dict_root;
|
---|
8011 | space_chain;
|
---|
8012 | space_chain = space_chain->sd_next)
|
---|
8013 | {
|
---|
8014 | if (space_chain->sd_seg == seg)
|
---|
8015 | return space_chain;
|
---|
8016 | }
|
---|
8017 |
|
---|
8018 | /* Mapping was not found. Return NULL. */
|
---|
8019 | return NULL;
|
---|
8020 | }
|
---|
8021 |
|
---|
8022 | /* Return the space chain entry for the subspace with the name NAME or
|
---|
8023 | NULL if no such subspace exists.
|
---|
8024 |
|
---|
8025 | Uses a linear search through all the spaces and subspaces, this may
|
---|
8026 | not be appropriate if we ever being placing each function in its
|
---|
8027 | own subspace. */
|
---|
8028 |
|
---|
8029 | static ssd_chain_struct *
|
---|
8030 | is_defined_subspace (name)
|
---|
8031 | char *name;
|
---|
8032 | {
|
---|
8033 | sd_chain_struct *space_chain;
|
---|
8034 | ssd_chain_struct *subspace_chain;
|
---|
8035 |
|
---|
8036 | /* Walk through each space. */
|
---|
8037 | for (space_chain = space_dict_root;
|
---|
8038 | space_chain;
|
---|
8039 | space_chain = space_chain->sd_next)
|
---|
8040 | {
|
---|
8041 | /* Walk through each subspace looking for a name which matches. */
|
---|
8042 | for (subspace_chain = space_chain->sd_subspaces;
|
---|
8043 | subspace_chain;
|
---|
8044 | subspace_chain = subspace_chain->ssd_next)
|
---|
8045 | if (strcmp (SUBSPACE_NAME (subspace_chain), name) == 0)
|
---|
8046 | return subspace_chain;
|
---|
8047 | }
|
---|
8048 |
|
---|
8049 | /* Subspace wasn't found. Return NULL. */
|
---|
8050 | return NULL;
|
---|
8051 | }
|
---|
8052 |
|
---|
8053 | /* Find and return the subspace associated with the given seg. If no
|
---|
8054 | mapping from the given seg to a subspace is found, then return NULL.
|
---|
8055 |
|
---|
8056 | If we ever put each procedure/function within its own subspace
|
---|
8057 | (to make life easier on the compiler and linker), then this will have
|
---|
8058 | to become more efficient. */
|
---|
8059 |
|
---|
8060 | static ssd_chain_struct *
|
---|
8061 | pa_subsegment_to_subspace (seg, subseg)
|
---|
8062 | asection *seg;
|
---|
8063 | subsegT subseg;
|
---|
8064 | {
|
---|
8065 | sd_chain_struct *space_chain;
|
---|
8066 | ssd_chain_struct *subspace_chain;
|
---|
8067 |
|
---|
8068 | /* Walk through each space. */
|
---|
8069 | for (space_chain = space_dict_root;
|
---|
8070 | space_chain;
|
---|
8071 | space_chain = space_chain->sd_next)
|
---|
8072 | {
|
---|
8073 | if (space_chain->sd_seg == seg)
|
---|
8074 | {
|
---|
8075 | /* Walk through each subspace within each space looking for
|
---|
8076 | the correct mapping. */
|
---|
8077 | for (subspace_chain = space_chain->sd_subspaces;
|
---|
8078 | subspace_chain;
|
---|
8079 | subspace_chain = subspace_chain->ssd_next)
|
---|
8080 | if (subspace_chain->ssd_subseg == (int) subseg)
|
---|
8081 | return subspace_chain;
|
---|
8082 | }
|
---|
8083 | }
|
---|
8084 |
|
---|
8085 | /* No mapping from subsegment to subspace found. Return NULL. */
|
---|
8086 | return NULL;
|
---|
8087 | }
|
---|
8088 |
|
---|
8089 | /* Given a number, try and find a space with the name number.
|
---|
8090 |
|
---|
8091 | Return a pointer to a space dictionary chain entry for the space
|
---|
8092 | that was found or NULL on failure. */
|
---|
8093 |
|
---|
8094 | static sd_chain_struct *
|
---|
8095 | pa_find_space_by_number (number)
|
---|
8096 | int number;
|
---|
8097 | {
|
---|
8098 | sd_chain_struct *space_chain;
|
---|
8099 |
|
---|
8100 | for (space_chain = space_dict_root;
|
---|
8101 | space_chain;
|
---|
8102 | space_chain = space_chain->sd_next)
|
---|
8103 | {
|
---|
8104 | if (SPACE_SPNUM (space_chain) == (unsigned int) number)
|
---|
8105 | return space_chain;
|
---|
8106 | }
|
---|
8107 |
|
---|
8108 | /* No appropriate space found. Return NULL. */
|
---|
8109 | return NULL;
|
---|
8110 | }
|
---|
8111 |
|
---|
8112 | /* Return the starting address for the given subspace. If the starting
|
---|
8113 | address is unknown then return zero. */
|
---|
8114 |
|
---|
8115 | static unsigned int
|
---|
8116 | pa_subspace_start (space, quadrant)
|
---|
8117 | sd_chain_struct *space;
|
---|
8118 | int quadrant;
|
---|
8119 | {
|
---|
8120 | /* FIXME. Assumes everyone puts read/write data at 0x4000000, this
|
---|
8121 | is not correct for the PA OSF1 port. */
|
---|
8122 | if ((strcmp (SPACE_NAME (space), "$PRIVATE$") == 0) && quadrant == 1)
|
---|
8123 | return 0x40000000;
|
---|
8124 | else if (space->sd_seg == data_section && quadrant == 1)
|
---|
8125 | return 0x40000000;
|
---|
8126 | else
|
---|
8127 | return 0;
|
---|
8128 | return 0;
|
---|
8129 | }
|
---|
8130 |
|
---|
8131 | /* FIXME. Needs documentation. */
|
---|
8132 | static int
|
---|
8133 | pa_next_subseg (space)
|
---|
8134 | sd_chain_struct *space;
|
---|
8135 | {
|
---|
8136 |
|
---|
8137 | space->sd_last_subseg++;
|
---|
8138 | return space->sd_last_subseg;
|
---|
8139 | }
|
---|
8140 | #endif
|
---|
8141 |
|
---|
8142 | /* Helper function for pa_stringer. Used to find the end of
|
---|
8143 | a string. */
|
---|
8144 |
|
---|
8145 | static unsigned int
|
---|
8146 | pa_stringer_aux (s)
|
---|
8147 | char *s;
|
---|
8148 | {
|
---|
8149 | unsigned int c = *s & CHAR_MASK;
|
---|
8150 |
|
---|
8151 | switch (c)
|
---|
8152 | {
|
---|
8153 | case '\"':
|
---|
8154 | c = NOT_A_CHAR;
|
---|
8155 | break;
|
---|
8156 | default:
|
---|
8157 | break;
|
---|
8158 | }
|
---|
8159 | return c;
|
---|
8160 | }
|
---|
8161 |
|
---|
8162 | /* Handle a .STRING type pseudo-op. */
|
---|
8163 |
|
---|
8164 | static void
|
---|
8165 | pa_stringer (append_zero)
|
---|
8166 | int append_zero;
|
---|
8167 | {
|
---|
8168 | char *s, num_buf[4];
|
---|
8169 | unsigned int c;
|
---|
8170 | int i;
|
---|
8171 |
|
---|
8172 | /* Preprocess the string to handle PA-specific escape sequences.
|
---|
8173 | For example, \xDD where DD is a hexadecimal number should be
|
---|
8174 | changed to \OOO where OOO is an octal number. */
|
---|
8175 |
|
---|
8176 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
8177 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
8178 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
8179 | #endif
|
---|
8180 |
|
---|
8181 | /* Skip the opening quote. */
|
---|
8182 | s = input_line_pointer + 1;
|
---|
8183 |
|
---|
8184 | while (is_a_char (c = pa_stringer_aux (s++)))
|
---|
8185 | {
|
---|
8186 | if (c == '\\')
|
---|
8187 | {
|
---|
8188 | c = *s;
|
---|
8189 | switch (c)
|
---|
8190 | {
|
---|
8191 | /* Handle \x<num>. */
|
---|
8192 | case 'x':
|
---|
8193 | {
|
---|
8194 | unsigned int number;
|
---|
8195 | int num_digit;
|
---|
8196 | char dg;
|
---|
8197 | char *s_start = s;
|
---|
8198 |
|
---|
8199 | /* Get past the 'x'. */
|
---|
8200 | s++;
|
---|
8201 | for (num_digit = 0, number = 0, dg = *s;
|
---|
8202 | num_digit < 2
|
---|
8203 | && (ISDIGIT (dg) || (dg >= 'a' && dg <= 'f')
|
---|
8204 | || (dg >= 'A' && dg <= 'F'));
|
---|
8205 | num_digit++)
|
---|
8206 | {
|
---|
8207 | if (ISDIGIT (dg))
|
---|
8208 | number = number * 16 + dg - '0';
|
---|
8209 | else if (dg >= 'a' && dg <= 'f')
|
---|
8210 | number = number * 16 + dg - 'a' + 10;
|
---|
8211 | else
|
---|
8212 | number = number * 16 + dg - 'A' + 10;
|
---|
8213 |
|
---|
8214 | s++;
|
---|
8215 | dg = *s;
|
---|
8216 | }
|
---|
8217 | if (num_digit > 0)
|
---|
8218 | {
|
---|
8219 | switch (num_digit)
|
---|
8220 | {
|
---|
8221 | case 1:
|
---|
8222 | sprintf (num_buf, "%02o", number);
|
---|
8223 | break;
|
---|
8224 | case 2:
|
---|
8225 | sprintf (num_buf, "%03o", number);
|
---|
8226 | break;
|
---|
8227 | }
|
---|
8228 | for (i = 0; i <= num_digit; i++)
|
---|
8229 | s_start[i] = num_buf[i];
|
---|
8230 | }
|
---|
8231 | break;
|
---|
8232 | }
|
---|
8233 | /* This might be a "\"", skip over the escaped char. */
|
---|
8234 | default:
|
---|
8235 | s++;
|
---|
8236 | break;
|
---|
8237 | }
|
---|
8238 | }
|
---|
8239 | }
|
---|
8240 | stringer (append_zero);
|
---|
8241 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8242 | }
|
---|
8243 |
|
---|
8244 | /* Handle a .VERSION pseudo-op. */
|
---|
8245 |
|
---|
8246 | static void
|
---|
8247 | pa_version (unused)
|
---|
8248 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
8249 | {
|
---|
8250 | obj_version (0);
|
---|
8251 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8252 | }
|
---|
8253 |
|
---|
8254 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
8255 |
|
---|
8256 | /* Handle a .COMPILER pseudo-op. */
|
---|
8257 |
|
---|
8258 | static void
|
---|
8259 | pa_compiler (unused)
|
---|
8260 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
8261 | {
|
---|
8262 | obj_som_compiler (0);
|
---|
8263 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8264 | }
|
---|
8265 |
|
---|
8266 | #endif
|
---|
8267 |
|
---|
8268 | /* Handle a .COPYRIGHT pseudo-op. */
|
---|
8269 |
|
---|
8270 | static void
|
---|
8271 | pa_copyright (unused)
|
---|
8272 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
8273 | {
|
---|
8274 | obj_copyright (0);
|
---|
8275 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8276 | }
|
---|
8277 |
|
---|
8278 | /* Just like a normal cons, but when finished we have to undefine
|
---|
8279 | the latest space label. */
|
---|
8280 |
|
---|
8281 | static void
|
---|
8282 | pa_cons (nbytes)
|
---|
8283 | int nbytes;
|
---|
8284 | {
|
---|
8285 | cons (nbytes);
|
---|
8286 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8287 | }
|
---|
8288 |
|
---|
8289 | /* Like float_cons, but we need to undefine our label. */
|
---|
8290 |
|
---|
8291 | static void
|
---|
8292 | pa_float_cons (float_type)
|
---|
8293 | int float_type;
|
---|
8294 | {
|
---|
8295 | float_cons (float_type);
|
---|
8296 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8297 | }
|
---|
8298 |
|
---|
8299 | /* Like s_fill, but delete our label when finished. */
|
---|
8300 |
|
---|
8301 | static void
|
---|
8302 | pa_fill (unused)
|
---|
8303 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
8304 | {
|
---|
8305 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
8306 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
8307 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
8308 | #endif
|
---|
8309 |
|
---|
8310 | s_fill (0);
|
---|
8311 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8312 | }
|
---|
8313 |
|
---|
8314 | /* Like lcomm, but delete our label when finished. */
|
---|
8315 |
|
---|
8316 | static void
|
---|
8317 | pa_lcomm (needs_align)
|
---|
8318 | int needs_align;
|
---|
8319 | {
|
---|
8320 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
8321 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
8322 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
8323 | #endif
|
---|
8324 |
|
---|
8325 | s_lcomm (needs_align);
|
---|
8326 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8327 | }
|
---|
8328 |
|
---|
8329 | /* Like lsym, but delete our label when finished. */
|
---|
8330 |
|
---|
8331 | static void
|
---|
8332 | pa_lsym (unused)
|
---|
8333 | int unused ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
8334 | {
|
---|
8335 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
8336 | /* We must have a valid space and subspace. */
|
---|
8337 | pa_check_current_space_and_subspace ();
|
---|
8338 | #endif
|
---|
8339 |
|
---|
8340 | s_lsym (0);
|
---|
8341 | pa_undefine_label ();
|
---|
8342 | }
|
---|
8343 |
|
---|
8344 | /* On the PA relocations which involve function symbols must not be
|
---|
8345 | adjusted. This so that the linker can know when/how to create argument
|
---|
8346 | relocation stubs for indirect calls and calls to static functions.
|
---|
8347 |
|
---|
8348 | "T" field selectors create DLT relative fixups for accessing
|
---|
8349 | globals and statics in PIC code; each DLT relative fixup creates
|
---|
8350 | an entry in the DLT table. The entries contain the address of
|
---|
8351 | the final target (eg accessing "foo" would create a DLT entry
|
---|
8352 | with the address of "foo").
|
---|
8353 |
|
---|
8354 | Unfortunately, the HP linker doesn't take into account any addend
|
---|
8355 | when generating the DLT; so accessing $LIT$+8 puts the address of
|
---|
8356 | $LIT$ into the DLT rather than the address of $LIT$+8.
|
---|
8357 |
|
---|
8358 | The end result is we can't perform relocation symbol reductions for
|
---|
8359 | any fixup which creates entries in the DLT (eg they use "T" field
|
---|
8360 | selectors).
|
---|
8361 |
|
---|
8362 | Reject reductions involving symbols with external scope; such
|
---|
8363 | reductions make life a living hell for object file editors.
|
---|
8364 |
|
---|
8365 | FIXME. Also reject R_HPPA relocations which are 32bits wide in
|
---|
8366 | the code space. The SOM BFD backend doesn't know how to pull the
|
---|
8367 | right bits out of an instruction. */
|
---|
8368 |
|
---|
8369 | int
|
---|
8370 | hppa_fix_adjustable (fixp)
|
---|
8371 | fixS *fixp;
|
---|
8372 | {
|
---|
8373 | reloc_type code;
|
---|
8374 | struct hppa_fix_struct *hppa_fix;
|
---|
8375 |
|
---|
8376 | hppa_fix = (struct hppa_fix_struct *) fixp->tc_fix_data;
|
---|
8377 |
|
---|
8378 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
8379 | /* Reject reductions of symbols in 32bit relocs. */
|
---|
8380 | if (fixp->fx_r_type == R_HPPA && hppa_fix->fx_r_format == 32)
|
---|
8381 | return 0;
|
---|
8382 | #endif
|
---|
8383 |
|
---|
8384 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
8385 | /* LR/RR selectors are implicitly used for a number of different relocation
|
---|
8386 | types. We must ensure that none of these types are adjusted (see below)
|
---|
8387 | even if they occur with a different selector. */
|
---|
8388 | code = elf_hppa_reloc_final_type (stdoutput, fixp->fx_r_type,
|
---|
8389 | hppa_fix->fx_r_format,
|
---|
8390 | hppa_fix->fx_r_field);
|
---|
8391 |
|
---|
8392 | switch (code)
|
---|
8393 | {
|
---|
8394 | /* Relocation types which use e_lrsel. */
|
---|
8395 | case R_PARISC_DIR21L:
|
---|
8396 | case R_PARISC_DLTREL21L:
|
---|
8397 | case R_PARISC_DPREL21L:
|
---|
8398 | case R_PARISC_PLTOFF21L:
|
---|
8399 |
|
---|
8400 | /* Relocation types which use e_rrsel. */
|
---|
8401 | case R_PARISC_DIR14R:
|
---|
8402 | case R_PARISC_DIR14DR:
|
---|
8403 | case R_PARISC_DIR14WR:
|
---|
8404 | case R_PARISC_DIR17R:
|
---|
8405 | case R_PARISC_DLTREL14R:
|
---|
8406 | case R_PARISC_DLTREL14DR:
|
---|
8407 | case R_PARISC_DLTREL14WR:
|
---|
8408 | case R_PARISC_DPREL14R:
|
---|
8409 | case R_PARISC_DPREL14DR:
|
---|
8410 | case R_PARISC_DPREL14WR:
|
---|
8411 | case R_PARISC_PLTOFF14R:
|
---|
8412 | case R_PARISC_PLTOFF14DR:
|
---|
8413 | case R_PARISC_PLTOFF14WR:
|
---|
8414 |
|
---|
8415 | /* Other types that we reject for reduction. */
|
---|
8416 | case R_PARISC_GNU_VTENTRY:
|
---|
8417 | case R_PARISC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
|
---|
8418 | return 0;
|
---|
8419 | default:
|
---|
8420 | break;
|
---|
8421 | }
|
---|
8422 | #endif
|
---|
8423 |
|
---|
8424 | /* Reject reductions of symbols in sym1-sym2 expressions when
|
---|
8425 | the fixup will occur in a CODE subspace.
|
---|
8426 |
|
---|
8427 | XXX FIXME: Long term we probably want to reject all of these;
|
---|
8428 | for example reducing in the debug section would lose if we ever
|
---|
8429 | supported using the optimizing hp linker. */
|
---|
8430 | if (fixp->fx_addsy
|
---|
8431 | && fixp->fx_subsy
|
---|
8432 | && (hppa_fix->segment->flags & SEC_CODE))
|
---|
8433 | return 0;
|
---|
8434 |
|
---|
8435 | /* We can't adjust any relocs that use LR% and RR% field selectors.
|
---|
8436 |
|
---|
8437 | If a symbol is reduced to a section symbol, the assembler will
|
---|
8438 | adjust the addend unless the symbol happens to reside right at
|
---|
8439 | the start of the section. Additionally, the linker has no choice
|
---|
8440 | but to manipulate the addends when coalescing input sections for
|
---|
8441 | "ld -r". Since an LR% field selector is defined to round the
|
---|
8442 | addend, we can't change the addend without risking that a LR% and
|
---|
8443 | it's corresponding (possible multiple) RR% field will no longer
|
---|
8444 | sum to the right value.
|
---|
8445 |
|
---|
8446 | eg. Suppose we have
|
---|
8447 | . ldil LR%foo+0,%r21
|
---|
8448 | . ldw RR%foo+0(%r21),%r26
|
---|
8449 | . ldw RR%foo+4(%r21),%r25
|
---|
8450 |
|
---|
8451 | If foo is at address 4092 (decimal) in section `sect', then after
|
---|
8452 | reducing to the section symbol we get
|
---|
8453 | . LR%sect+4092 == (L%sect)+0
|
---|
8454 | . RR%sect+4092 == (R%sect)+4092
|
---|
8455 | . RR%sect+4096 == (R%sect)-4096
|
---|
8456 | and the last address loses because rounding the addend to 8k
|
---|
8457 | mutiples takes us up to 8192 with an offset of -4096.
|
---|
8458 |
|
---|
8459 | In cases where the LR% expression is identical to the RR% one we
|
---|
8460 | will never have a problem, but is so happens that gcc rounds
|
---|
8461 | addends involved in LR% field selectors to work around a HP
|
---|
8462 | linker bug. ie. We often have addresses like the last case
|
---|
8463 | above where the LR% expression is offset from the RR% one. */
|
---|
8464 |
|
---|
8465 | if (hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_lrsel
|
---|
8466 | || hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_rrsel
|
---|
8467 | || hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_nlrsel)
|
---|
8468 | return 0;
|
---|
8469 |
|
---|
8470 | /* Reject reductions of symbols in DLT relative relocs,
|
---|
8471 | relocations with plabels. */
|
---|
8472 | if (hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_tsel
|
---|
8473 | || hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_ltsel
|
---|
8474 | || hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_rtsel
|
---|
8475 | || hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_psel
|
---|
8476 | || hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_rpsel
|
---|
8477 | || hppa_fix->fx_r_field == e_lpsel)
|
---|
8478 | return 0;
|
---|
8479 |
|
---|
8480 | /* Reject absolute calls (jumps). */
|
---|
8481 | if (hppa_fix->fx_r_type == R_HPPA_ABS_CALL)
|
---|
8482 | return 0;
|
---|
8483 |
|
---|
8484 | /* Reject reductions of function symbols. */
|
---|
8485 | if (fixp->fx_addsy != 0 && S_IS_FUNCTION (fixp->fx_addsy))
|
---|
8486 | return 0;
|
---|
8487 |
|
---|
8488 | return 1;
|
---|
8489 | }
|
---|
8490 |
|
---|
8491 | /* Return nonzero if the fixup in FIXP will require a relocation,
|
---|
8492 | even it if appears that the fixup could be completely handled
|
---|
8493 | within GAS. */
|
---|
8494 |
|
---|
8495 | int
|
---|
8496 | hppa_force_relocation (fixp)
|
---|
8497 | struct fix *fixp;
|
---|
8498 | {
|
---|
8499 | struct hppa_fix_struct *hppa_fixp;
|
---|
8500 |
|
---|
8501 | hppa_fixp = (struct hppa_fix_struct *) fixp->tc_fix_data;
|
---|
8502 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
8503 | if (fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_ENTRY
|
---|
8504 | || fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_EXIT
|
---|
8505 | || fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_BEGIN_BRTAB
|
---|
8506 | || fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_END_BRTAB
|
---|
8507 | || fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_BEGIN_TRY
|
---|
8508 | || fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_END_TRY
|
---|
8509 | || (fixp->fx_addsy != NULL && fixp->fx_subsy != NULL
|
---|
8510 | && (hppa_fixp->segment->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
|
---|
8511 | return 1;
|
---|
8512 | #endif
|
---|
8513 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
8514 | if (fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_PARISC_GNU_VTINHERIT
|
---|
8515 | || fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_PARISC_GNU_VTENTRY)
|
---|
8516 | return 1;
|
---|
8517 | #endif
|
---|
8518 |
|
---|
8519 | assert (fixp->fx_addsy != NULL);
|
---|
8520 |
|
---|
8521 | /* Ensure we emit a relocation for global symbols so that dynamic
|
---|
8522 | linking works. */
|
---|
8523 | if (S_FORCE_RELOC (fixp->fx_addsy, 1))
|
---|
8524 | return 1;
|
---|
8525 |
|
---|
8526 | /* It is necessary to force PC-relative calls/jumps to have a relocation
|
---|
8527 | entry if they're going to need either an argument relocation or long
|
---|
8528 | call stub. */
|
---|
8529 | if (fixp->fx_pcrel
|
---|
8530 | && arg_reloc_stub_needed (symbol_arg_reloc_info (fixp->fx_addsy),
|
---|
8531 | hppa_fixp->fx_arg_reloc))
|
---|
8532 | return 1;
|
---|
8533 |
|
---|
8534 | /* Now check to see if we're going to need a long-branch stub. */
|
---|
8535 | if (fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_PCREL_CALL)
|
---|
8536 | {
|
---|
8537 | long pc = md_pcrel_from (fixp);
|
---|
8538 | valueT distance, min_stub_distance;
|
---|
8539 |
|
---|
8540 | distance = fixp->fx_offset + S_GET_VALUE (fixp->fx_addsy) - pc - 8;
|
---|
8541 |
|
---|
8542 | /* Distance to the closest possible stub. This will detect most
|
---|
8543 | but not all circumstances where a stub will not work. */
|
---|
8544 | min_stub_distance = pc + 16;
|
---|
8545 | #ifdef OBJ_SOM
|
---|
8546 | if (last_call_info != NULL)
|
---|
8547 | min_stub_distance -= S_GET_VALUE (last_call_info->start_symbol);
|
---|
8548 | #endif
|
---|
8549 |
|
---|
8550 | if ((distance + 8388608 >= 16777216
|
---|
8551 | && min_stub_distance <= 8388608)
|
---|
8552 | || (hppa_fixp->fx_r_format == 17
|
---|
8553 | && distance + 262144 >= 524288
|
---|
8554 | && min_stub_distance <= 262144)
|
---|
8555 | || (hppa_fixp->fx_r_format == 12
|
---|
8556 | && distance + 8192 >= 16384
|
---|
8557 | && min_stub_distance <= 8192)
|
---|
8558 | )
|
---|
8559 | return 1;
|
---|
8560 | }
|
---|
8561 |
|
---|
8562 | if (fixp->fx_r_type == (int) R_HPPA_ABS_CALL)
|
---|
8563 | return 1;
|
---|
8564 |
|
---|
8565 | /* No need (yet) to force another relocations to be emitted. */
|
---|
8566 | return 0;
|
---|
8567 | }
|
---|
8568 |
|
---|
8569 | /* Now for some ELF specific code. FIXME. */
|
---|
8570 | #ifdef OBJ_ELF
|
---|
8571 | /* Mark the end of a function so that it's possible to compute
|
---|
8572 | the size of the function in elf_hppa_final_processing. */
|
---|
8573 |
|
---|
8574 | static void
|
---|
8575 | hppa_elf_mark_end_of_function ()
|
---|
8576 | {
|
---|
8577 | /* ELF does not have EXIT relocations. All we do is create a
|
---|
8578 | temporary symbol marking the end of the function. */
|
---|
8579 | char *name;
|
---|
8580 |
|
---|
8581 | if (last_call_info == NULL || last_call_info->start_symbol == NULL)
|
---|
8582 | {
|
---|
8583 | /* We have already warned about a missing label,
|
---|
8584 | or other problems. */
|
---|
8585 | return;
|
---|
8586 | }
|
---|
8587 |
|
---|
8588 | name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen ("L$\001end_")
|
---|
8589 | + strlen (S_GET_NAME (last_call_info->start_symbol))
|
---|
8590 | + 1);
|
---|
8591 | if (name)
|
---|
8592 | {
|
---|
8593 | symbolS *symbolP;
|
---|
8594 |
|
---|
8595 | strcpy (name, "L$\001end_");
|
---|
8596 | strcat (name, S_GET_NAME (last_call_info->start_symbol));
|
---|
8597 |
|
---|
8598 | /* If we have a .exit followed by a .procend, then the
|
---|
8599 | symbol will have already been defined. */
|
---|
8600 | symbolP = symbol_find (name);
|
---|
8601 | if (symbolP)
|
---|
8602 | {
|
---|
8603 | /* The symbol has already been defined! This can
|
---|
8604 | happen if we have a .exit followed by a .procend.
|
---|
8605 |
|
---|
8606 | This is *not* an error. All we want to do is free
|
---|
8607 | the memory we just allocated for the name and continue. */
|
---|
8608 | xfree (name);
|
---|
8609 | }
|
---|
8610 | else
|
---|
8611 | {
|
---|
8612 | /* symbol value should be the offset of the
|
---|
8613 | last instruction of the function */
|
---|
8614 | symbolP = symbol_new (name, now_seg, (valueT) (frag_now_fix () - 4),
|
---|
8615 | frag_now);
|
---|
8616 |
|
---|
8617 | assert (symbolP);
|
---|
8618 | S_CLEAR_EXTERNAL (symbolP);
|
---|
8619 | symbol_table_insert (symbolP);
|
---|
8620 | }
|
---|
8621 |
|
---|
8622 | if (symbolP)
|
---|
8623 | last_call_info->end_symbol = symbolP;
|
---|
8624 | else
|
---|
8625 | as_bad (_("Symbol '%s' could not be created."), name);
|
---|
8626 |
|
---|
8627 | }
|
---|
8628 | else
|
---|
8629 | as_bad (_("No memory for symbol name."));
|
---|
8630 |
|
---|
8631 | }
|
---|
8632 |
|
---|
8633 | /* For ELF, this function serves one purpose: to setup the st_size
|
---|
8634 | field of STT_FUNC symbols. To do this, we need to scan the
|
---|
8635 | call_info structure list, determining st_size in by taking the
|
---|
8636 | difference in the address of the beginning/end marker symbols. */
|
---|
8637 |
|
---|
8638 | void
|
---|
8639 | elf_hppa_final_processing ()
|
---|
8640 | {
|
---|
8641 | struct call_info *call_info_pointer;
|
---|
8642 |
|
---|
8643 | for (call_info_pointer = call_info_root;
|
---|
8644 | call_info_pointer;
|
---|
8645 | call_info_pointer = call_info_pointer->ci_next)
|
---|
8646 | {
|
---|
8647 | elf_symbol_type *esym
|
---|
8648 | = ((elf_symbol_type *)
|
---|
8649 | symbol_get_bfdsym (call_info_pointer->start_symbol));
|
---|
8650 | esym->internal_elf_sym.st_size =
|
---|
8651 | S_GET_VALUE (call_info_pointer->end_symbol)
|
---|
8652 | - S_GET_VALUE (call_info_pointer->start_symbol) + 4;
|
---|
8653 | }
|
---|
8654 | }
|
---|
8655 |
|
---|
8656 | static void
|
---|
8657 | pa_vtable_entry (ignore)
|
---|
8658 | int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
8659 | {
|
---|
8660 | struct fix *new_fix;
|
---|
8661 |
|
---|
8662 | new_fix = obj_elf_vtable_entry (0);
|
---|
8663 |
|
---|
8664 | if (new_fix)
|
---|
8665 | {
|
---|
8666 | struct hppa_fix_struct *hppa_fix = (struct hppa_fix_struct *)
|
---|
8667 | obstack_alloc (¬es, sizeof (struct hppa_fix_struct));
|
---|
8668 | hppa_fix->fx_r_type = R_HPPA;
|
---|
8669 | hppa_fix->fx_r_field = e_fsel;
|
---|
8670 | hppa_fix->fx_r_format = 32;
|
---|
8671 | hppa_fix->fx_arg_reloc = 0;
|
---|
8672 | hppa_fix->segment = now_seg;
|
---|
8673 | new_fix->tc_fix_data = (void *) hppa_fix;
|
---|
8674 | new_fix->fx_r_type = (int) R_PARISC_GNU_VTENTRY;
|
---|
8675 | }
|
---|
8676 | }
|
---|
8677 |
|
---|
8678 | static void
|
---|
8679 | pa_vtable_inherit (ignore)
|
---|
8680 | int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
---|
8681 | {
|
---|
8682 | struct fix *new_fix;
|
---|
8683 |
|
---|
8684 | new_fix = obj_elf_vtable_inherit (0);
|
---|
8685 |
|
---|
8686 | if (new_fix)
|
---|
8687 | {
|
---|
8688 | struct hppa_fix_struct *hppa_fix = (struct hppa_fix_struct *)
|
---|
8689 | obstack_alloc (¬es, sizeof (struct hppa_fix_struct));
|
---|
8690 | hppa_fix->fx_r_type = R_HPPA;
|
---|
8691 | hppa_fix->fx_r_field = e_fsel;
|
---|
8692 | hppa_fix->fx_r_format = 32;
|
---|
8693 | hppa_fix->fx_arg_reloc = 0;
|
---|
8694 | hppa_fix->segment = now_seg;
|
---|
8695 | new_fix->tc_fix_data = (void *) hppa_fix;
|
---|
8696 | new_fix->fx_r_type = (int) R_PARISC_GNU_VTINHERIT;
|
---|
8697 | }
|
---|
8698 | }
|
---|
8699 | #endif
|
---|